Você está na página 1de 334

2008 Civic Coupe

Owner’s Manual
(Unlinked)

This document does not contain hyperlinks and may be formatted for printing instead of web us. This is due to changes
in content and specifications of the vehicle that happen throughout the model year. This manual will be replaced with a
hyperlinked version at the end of the model year.
© 2007 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. P/N 00X31-SVA-6210
07/10/30 14:05:06 31SVA620 0001 

Owner’s Identification

OWNER This owner’s manual should be considered


a permanent part of the vehicle and should
remain with the vehicle when it is sold.

This owner’s manual covers all models of


ADDRESS the Civic 2-door. You may find descriptions
STREET of equipment and features that are not on
your particular model.

The information and specifications included


CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/ in this publication were in effect at the time
POSTAL CODE of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,
V. I. N. Ltd. reserves the right, however, to
discontinue or change specifications or
design at any time without notice and
DELIVERY DATE without incurring any obligation whatsoever.
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)

DEALER NAME DEALER NO. POUR CLIENTS CANADIEN


AVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avez
besoin d’un Manuel du Conducteur
ADDRESS en français, veuillez demander à
STREET votre concessionnaire de
commander le numéro de pièce
33SVAC21
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/
POSTAL CODE
OWNER’S SIGNATURE

DEALER’S SIGNATURE
07/07/11 15:06:47 31SVA620 0002 

Introduction

Congratulations! Your selection of a 2008 Honda Civic was a wise investment. As you read this manual, you will
It will give you years of driving pleasure. find information that is preceded by
a symbol. This
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is to information is intended to help you
read this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls and avoid damage to your vehicle, other
convenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle so property, or the environment.
you can refer to it at any time.

Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty booklet
thoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rights
and responsibilities.

Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in the


instrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves
your investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind that
your dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems unique
to your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will be
pleased to answer any questions and concerns.

i
07/07/11 15:06:51 31SVA620 0003 

Introduction

California Proposition 65 Warning

WARNING: This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm.

Event Data Recorders


This vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. These
devices record front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failure
of any airbag system component. This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else
except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner.

Service Diagnostic Recorders


This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The data
can be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It may
also be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential.

ii
07/07/11 15:07:02 31SVA620 0004 

A Few Words About Safety

Your safety, and the safety of others, You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
is very important. And operating this including:
vehicle safely is an important
responsibility. Safety Labels − on the vehicle.
Safety Messages − preceded by a safety alert symbol and one of
To help you make informed three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
decisions about safety, we have These signal words mean:
provided operating procedures and
other information on labels and in You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY
this manual. This information alerts HURT if you don’t follow instructions.
you to potential hazards that could
hurt you or others. You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY
HURT if you don’t follow instructions.
Of course, it is not practical or
possible to warn you about all the You CAN be HURT if you don’t follow
hazards associated with operating or instructions.
maintaining your vehicle. You must
use your own good judgement. Safety Headings − such as Important Safety Reminders or Important
Safety Precautions.
Safety Section − such as Driver and Passenger Safety.
Instructions − how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.

This entire book is filled with important safety information − please read it
carefully.

iii
07/07/11 15:07:04 31SVA620 0005 
07/07/11 15:07:14 31SVA620 0006 

Contents

Your Vehicle at a Glance (main controls) ................................................................................................ 3

Driver and Passenger Safety (seat belts, SRS, and child protection) ............................................................. 5

Instruments and Controls (indicators, gauges, dashboard, and steering column) ........................................... 53

Features (heating and cooling, audio, steering wheel, security, and cruise control) ........................................ 113

Before Driving (fuel, vehicle break-in, and cargo loading) ........................................................................ 185

Driving (engine and transmission operation).......................................................................................... 201

Maintenance (minder, fluid checking, minor services, and vehicle storage).................................................. 223

Taking Care of the Unexpected (flat tire, dead battery, overheating, and fuses) .......................................... 269

Technical Information (vehicle specifications, tires, and emissions controls)............................................... 293

Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada only) (warranty and contact information)................... 311

Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) (how to order) ................................................................................... 315

Index ................................................................................................................................................. I

INDEX
Service Information Summary (fluid capacities and tire pressures) ................................................... last page

1
07/07/11 15:07:31 31SVA620 0007 

Overview of Contents

Contents Before Driving Warranty and Customer


A convenient reference to the What gasoline to use, how to break- Relations
sections in this manual. in your new vehicle, and how to load (U.S. and Canada only)
luggage and other cargo. A summary of the warranties
Your Vehicle at a Glance covering your new vehicle, and how
A quick reference to the main Driving to contact us for any reason. Refer to
controls in your vehicle. The proper way to start the engine, your warranty manual for detailed
shift the transmission, and park. information.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Important information about the Maintenance Authorized Manuals
proper use and care of your vehicle’s The maintenance minder shows you (U.S. only)
seat belts, an overview of the when you need to take your vehicle How to order manuals and other
supplemental restraint system, and to the dealer for maintenance service. technical literature.
valuable information on how to There is also a list of things to check
protect children with child restraints. and instructions on how to check Index
them.
Instruments and Controls Service Information Summary
Explains the purpose of each Taking Care of the Unexpected A summary of the information you
instrument panel indicator and gauge, This section covers several problems need when you pull up to the fuel
and how to use the controls on the motorists sometimes experience, pump.
dashboard and steering column. and details how to handle them.

Features Technical Information


How to operate the heating and air ID numbers, dimensions, capacities,
conditioning system, the audio and technical information.
system, and other convenience
features.
2
07/07/11 15:07:39 31SVA620 0008 

Your Vehicle at a Glance

INSTRUMENT PANEL HAZARD WARNING MOONROOF SWITCH* (P.102)


INDICATORS (P.55, 56) BUTTON (P.74)

Your Vehicle at a Glance


GAUGES (P.65) CLOCK* (P.180)

DRIVER’S FRONT AIRBAG


(P.9, 23)

PASSENGER’S FRONT
MIRROR CONTROLS* AIRBAG (P.9, 23)
(P.104)

AUDIO SYSTEM*
(P.119)
POWER DOOR LOCK
MASTER SWITCH*
(P.80)

HEATING/COOLING*
POWER WINDOW CONTROLS
SWITCHES* (P.114)
(P.100)

HOOD RELEASE
HANDLE
(P.188) AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
FUEL FILL DOOR/ ACCESSORY POWER (P.208)
TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE SOCKETS MANUAL TRANSMISSION
A/T model is shown. (P.187, 90) (P.108) (P.205)

*: If equipped
3
07/07/11 15:07:47 31SVA620 0009 

Your Vehicle at a Glance

HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNALS WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS


(P.72) (P.71) PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
INDICATOR (P.29)
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRIGHTNESS
(P.73)
DISPLAY CHANGE
BUTTON
(P.66)
SEL/RESET BUTTON
(P.65)
REAR WINDOW
MIRROR CONTROLS*3 DEFOGGER
(P.104) (P.74)
HEATED MIRRORS*3
VEHICLE (P.105)
STABILITY HORN*2
ASSIST (VSA) HAZARD WARNING
SYSTEM OFF BUTTON
SWITCH*3 STEERING WHEEL (P.74)
(P.217) ADJUSTMENTS (P.75)
ACCESSORY POWER
REMOTE AUDIO SOCKET
CRUISE (P.108)
CONTROLS*3 (P.177) CONTROL
BUTTONS*3 AUXILIARY INPUT JACK*3
NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS*1 (P.182) (P.178)

*1 : Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.
*2 : To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
*3 : If equipped.
4
07/07/11 15:07:51 31SVA620 0010 

Driver and Passenger Safety

This section gives you important Additional Information About All Children Should Sit in a
information about how to protect Your Seat Belts ........................ 18 Back Seat .................................. 33
yourself and your passengers. It Seat Belt System Components ... 18 The Passenger’s Front Airbag
shows you how to use seat belts. It Lap/Shoulder Belt ....................... 19 Can Pose Serious Risks .......... 33

Driver and Passenger Safety


explains how your airbags work. And Automatic Seat Belt If You Must Drive with Several
it tells you how to properly restrain Tensioners ................................ 19 Children .................................... 35
infants and children in your vehicle. Seat Belt Maintenance ................ 20 If a Child Requires Close
Additional Information About Attention ................................... 35
Your Airbags ............................ 21 Additional Safety Precautions .... 35
Airbag System Components ....... 21 Protecting Infants and Small
How Your Front Airbags Children .................................... 37
Work.......................................... 23 Protecting Infants ........................ 37
How Your Side Airbags Work.... 26 Protecting Small Children .......... 38
Important Safety Precautions .......... 6 How the Side Curtain Airbags Selecting a Child Seat ...................... 39
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features........ 7 Work.......................................... 28 Installing a Child Seat ..................... 40
Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 28 With LATCH ................................ 41
1. Close and Lock the Doors ...... 11 How the Side Airbag Off With a Lap/Shoulder Belt .......... 43
2. Adjust the Front Seats ............ 11 Indicator Works ....................... 29 With a Tether ............................... 45
3. Adjust the Seat-Backs ............. 12 How the Passenger Airbag Off Protecting Larger Children ............ 46
4. Adjust the Head Restraints .... 13 Indicator Works ....................... 29 Checking Seat Belt Fit ................ 46
5. Fasten and Position the Seat Airbag Service .............................. 30 Using a Booster Seat ................... 47
Belts ...................................... 14 Additional Safety Precautions .... 31 When Can a Larger Child Sit in
6. Maintain a Proper Sitting Protecting Children − General Front .......................................... 48
Position ................................. 15 Guidelines ................................. 32 Additional Safety Precautions .... 49
Advice for Pregnant Women...... 16 All Children Must Be Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 50
Additional Safety Precautions .... 16 Restrained ................................ 32 Safety Labels .................................... 51

5
07/07/11 15:08:01 31SVA620 0011 

Important Safety Precautions

You’ll find many safety Restrain All Children every additional drink. So don’t drink
recommendations throughout this Children age 12 and under should and drive, and don’t let your friends
section, and throughout this manual. ride properly restrained in a back drink and drive, either.
The recommendations on this page seat, not the front seat. Infants and
are the ones we consider to be the small children should be restrained Control Your Speed
most important. in a child seat. Larger children Excessive speed is a major factor in
should use a booster seat and a lap/ crash injuries and deaths. Generally,
Always Wear Your Seat Belt shoulder belt until they can use the the higher the speed, the greater the
A seat belt is your best protection in belt properly without a booster seat risk, but serious injuries can also
all types of collisions. Airbags are (see pages 32 − 49 ). occur at lower speeds. Never drive
designed to supplement seat belts, faster than is safe for current
not replace them. So even though Be Aware of Airbag Hazards conditions, regardless of the
your vehicle is equipped with airbags, While airbags can save lives, they maximum speed posted.
make sure you and your passengers can cause serious or fatal injuries to
always wear your seat belts, and occupants who sit too close to them, Keep Your Vehicle in Safe
wear them properly (see page 14 ). or are not properly restrained. Condition
Infants, young children, and short Having a tire blowout or a
adults are at the greatest risk. Be mechanical failure can be extremely
sure to follow all instructions and hazardous. To reduce the possibility
warnings in this manual. of such problems, check your tire
pressures and condition frequently,
Don’t Drink and Drive and perform all regularly scheduled
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even maintenance (see page 225 ).
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions, and
your reaction time gets worse with

6
07/07/11 15:08:09 31SVA620 0012 

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features

Your vehicle is equipped with many


(1) (3) (4) (6) (9) features that work together to
(8) protect you and your passengers
(11) during a crash.

Driver and Passenger Safety


(7) Some features do not require any
action on your part. These include a
(5) strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger
compartment, front and rear crush
zones, a collapsible steering column,
(2) and tensioners that tighten the front
(10) seat belts in a crash.
(12) (8)
(7) However, you and your passengers
(1) Safety Cage can’t take full advantage of these
(2) Crush Zone
(3) Seats and Seat-Backs features unless you remain sitting in
(2) (4) Head Restraints a proper position and always wear
(5) Collapsible Steering Column your seat belts. In fact, some safety
(6) Seat Belts
(7) Front Airbags features can contribute to injuries if
(8) Side Airbags they are not used properly.
(9) Side Curtain Airbags
(10) Front Seat Belt Tensioners The following pages explain how you
(11) Door Locks
(12) Front Seat Belt Buckle can take an active role in protecting
Tensioners yourself and your passengers.

7
07/07/11 15:08:20 31SVA620 0013 

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features

Seat Belts Help keep you from being thrown


Your vehicle is equipped with seat against the inside of the vehicle
belts in all seating positions. Not wearing a seat belt properly and against other occupants.
increases the chance of serious
Your seat belt system also includes injury or death in a crash, even Keep you from being thrown out
an indicator on the instrument panel though your vehicle has airbags. of the vehicle.
and a beeper to remind you and your
passengers to fasten your seat belts. Be sure you and your Help keep you in a good position
passengers always wear seat should the airbags ever deploy. A
Why Wear Seat Belts belts and wear them properly. good position reduces the risk of
Seat belts are the single most injury from an inflating airbag and
effective safety device for adults and allows you to get the best
larger children. (Infants and smaller When properly worn, seat belts: advantage from the airbag.
children must be properly restrained
in child seats.) Keep you connected to the vehicle Of course, seat belts cannot
so you can take advantage of the completely protect you in every
Not wearing a seat belt properly vehicle’s built-in safety features. crash. But in most cases, seat belts
increases the chance of serious can reduce your risk of serious
injury or death in a crash, even Help protect you in almost every injury.
though your vehicle has airbags. type of crash, including frontal,
side, and rear impacts and What You Should Do:
In addition, most states and all rollovers. Always wear your seat belt, and
Canadian provinces require you to make sure you wear it properly.
wear seat belts.

8
07/07/24 19:15:10 31SVA620 0014 

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features

Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety


Your vehicle has a supplemental Your vehicle also has side airbags to In addition, your vehicle has side
restraint system (SRS) with front help protect the upper torso of the curtain airbags to help protect the
airbags to help protect the heads and driver or a front seat passenger heads of the driver, front passenger,
chests of the driver and a front seat during a moderate to severe side and passengers in the outer rear
passenger during a moderate to impact (see page 26 for more seating positions during a moderate
severe frontal collision (see page information on how your side airbags to severe side impact (see page
23 for more information on how work). 28 for more information on how
your front airbags work). your side curtain airbags work).

CONTINUED

9
07/07/11 15:08:32 31SVA620 0015 

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features

The most important things you need What you should do: Always wear The rest of this section gives more
to know about your airbags are: your seat belt properly, and sit detailed information about how you
upright and as far back from the can maximize your safety.
Airbags do not replace seat belts. steering wheel as possible while
They are designed to supplement allowing full control of the vehicle. A Remember, however, that no safety
the seat belts. front passenger should move their system can prevent all injuries or
seat as far back from the dashboard deaths that can occur in a severe
Airbags offer no protection in rear as possible. crash, even when seat belts are
impacts, or minor frontal or side properly worn and the airbags deploy.
collisions.

Airbags can pose hazards. To do


their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So while
airbags help save lives, they can
cause minor injuries or more
serious or even fatal injuries if
occupants are not properly
restrained or sitting properly.

10
07/07/11 15:08:41 31SVA620 0016 

Protecting Adults and Teens

Introduction Locking the doors reduces the 2.Adjust the Front Seats
The following pages provide chance of someone being thrown out
instructions on how to properly of the vehicle during a crash, and it
protect the driver, adult passengers, helps prevent passengers from

Driver and Passenger Safety


and teenage children who are large accidentally opening a door and
enough and mature enough to drive falling out.
or ride in the front.
Locking the doors also helps prevent
See pages 32 − 36 for important an outsider from unexpectedly
guidelines on how to properly opening a door when you come to a
protect infants, small children, and stop.
larger children who ride in your
vehicle. See page 79 for how to lock the
doors, and page 63 for how the door-
1.Close and Lock the Doors open indicator works. Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the
After everyone has entered the rear as possible while allowing you to
vehicle, be sure the doors are closed Some models have the auto door maintain full control of the vehicle.
and locked. locking/unlocking feature. For more Have a front passenger adjust their
information, see page 81 . seat as far to the rear as possible.
Your vehicle has a door-
open indicator on the
instrument panel to indicate when
either door is not tightly closed.

CONTINUED

11
07/07/11 15:08:50 31SVA620 0017 

Protecting Adults and Teens

If you sit too close to the steering 3.Adjust the Seat-Backs


wheel or dashboard, you can be
seriously injured by an inflating front Sitting too close to a front
airbag, or by striking the steering airbag can result in serious
wheel or dashboard. injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration and Transport Always sit as far back from the
Canada recommend that drivers front airbags as possible.
allow at least 10 inches (25 cm)
between the center of the steering
wheel and the chest. In addition to Once your seat is adjusted correctly,
adjusting the seat, you can adjust the rock it back and forth to make sure
steering wheel up and down, and in the seat is locked in position.
and out (see page 75 ). Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a
See page 92 for how to adjust the comfortable, upright position,
If you cannot get far enough away front seats. leaving ample space between your
from the steering wheel and still chest and the airbag cover in the
reach the controls, we recommend center of the steering wheel.
that you investigate whether some
type of adaptive equipment may help. Passengers with adjustable seat-
backs should also adjust their seat-
back to a comfortable, upright
position.

12
07/07/11 15:08:58 31SVA620 0018 

Protecting Adults and Teens

4.Adjust the Head Restraints

Reclining the seat-back too far Improperly positioning head


can result in serious injury or restraints reduces their

Driver and Passenger Safety


death in a crash. effectiveness and you can be
seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an
upright position, and sit well Make sure head restraints are
back in the seat. in place and positioned properly
before driving.

Reclining a seat-back so that the


shoulder part of the belt no longer Properly adjusted head restraints
rests against the occupant’s chest will help protect occupants from
reduces the protective capability of Adjust the driver’s head restraint so whiplash and other crash injuries.
the belt. It also increases the chance the center of the back of your head
of sliding under the belt in a crash rests against the center of the See page 95 for how to adjust the
and being seriously injured. The restraint. head restraints and how the driver’s
farther a seat-back is reclined, the and front passenger’s active head
greater the risk of injury. Have passengers adjust their head restraints work.
restraints properly as well. Taller
See page 92 for how to adjust the persons should adjust their restraint
seat-backs. as high as possible.

13
07/07/11 15:09:04 31SVA620 0019 

Protecting Adults and Teens

5.Fasten and Position the Seat This spreads the forces of a crash
Belts over the strongest bones in your
Insert the latch plate into the buckle, upper body.
then tug on the belt to make sure the
belt is securely latched. Check that
the belt is not twisted, because a
twisted belt can cause serious Improperly positioning the seat
injuries in a crash. belts can cause serious injury
or death in a crash.

Make sure all seat belts are


properly positioned before
driving.
Position the lap part of the belt as
low as possible across your hips,
then pull up on the shoulder part of
the belt so the lap part fits snugly.
This lets your strong pelvic bones
take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.

If necessary, pull up on the belt again


to remove any slack, then check that
the belt rests across the center of
your chest and over your shoulder.

14
07/07/11 15:09:12 31SVA620 0020 

Protecting Adults and Teens

Never place the shoulder portion of a 6.Maintain a Proper Sitting In addition, an occupant who is out of
lap/shoulder belt under your arm or Position position in the front seat can be
behind your back. This could cause After all occupants have adjusted seriously or fatally injured in a crash
very serious injuries in a crash. their seats and head restraints, and by striking interior parts of the

Driver and Passenger Safety


put on their seat belts, it is very vehicle or being struck by an
If a seat belt does not seem to work important that they continue to sit inflating front airbag.
properly, it may not protect the upright, well back in their seats, with
occupant in a crash. their feet on the floor, until the
vehicle is parked and the engine is
No one should sit in a seat with an off. Sitting improperly or out of
inoperative seat belt. Using a seat position can result in serious
belt that is not working properly can Sitting improperly can increase the injury or death in a crash.
result in serious injury or death. chance of injury during a crash. For
Have your dealer check the belt as example, if an occupant slouches, Always sit upright, well back in
soon as possible. lies down, turns sideways, sits the seat, with your feet on the
forward, leans forward or sideways, floor.
See page 18 for additional or puts one or both feet up, the
information about your seat belts chance of injury during a crash is
and how to take care of them. greatly increased.

15
07/07/11 15:09:20 31SVA620 0021 

Protecting Adults and Teens

Advice for Pregnant Women When driving, remember to sit Additional Safety Precautions
upright and adjust the seat as far Two people should never use the
back as possible while allowing full same seat belt. If they do, they
control of the vehicle. When riding could be very seriously injured in a
as a front passenger, adjust the seat crash.
as far back as possible.
Do not put any accessories on seat
This will reduce the risk of injuries belts. Devices intended to improve
to both you and your unborn child occupant comfort or reposition the
that can be caused by a crash or an shoulder part of a seat belt can
inflating front airbag. reduce the protective capability of
the belt and increase the chance of
Each time you have a checkup, ask serious injury in a crash.
your doctor if it’s okay for you to
If you are pregnant, the best way to drive. Do not place hard or sharp objects
protect yourself and your unborn between yourself and a front
child when driving or riding in a airbag. Carrying hard or sharp
vehicle is to always wear a seat belt, objects on your lap, or driving with
and keep the lap part of the belt as a pipe or other sharp object in
low as possible across the hips. your mouth, can result in injuries
if your front airbag inflates.

16
07/07/11 15:09:24 31SVA620 0022 

Protecting Adults and Teens

Keep your hands and arms away Never let passengers ride on top of
from the airbag covers. If your a folded-down rear seat. If they do,
hands or arms are close to an they could be very seriously
airbag cover, they could be injured injured in a crash.

Driver and Passenger Safety


if the airbag inflates.

Do not attach or place objects on


the front airbag covers. Objects on
the covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’
could interfere with the proper
operation of the airbags or be
propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone if the airbags inflate.

Do not attach hard objects on or


near a door. If a side airbag or a
side curtain airbag inflates, a cup
holder or other hard object
attached on or near the door could
be propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone.

17
07/07/11 15:09:33 31SVA620 0023 

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Seat Belt System Components This system monitors the front seat If the indicator comes on or the
Your seat belt system includes lap/ belts. If you turn the ignition switch beeper sounds when the driver’s seat
shoulder belts in all five seating to the ON (II) position before your belt is latched and there is no front
positions. The front seat belts are seat belt is fastened, the beeper will seat passenger and no items on the
also equipped with automatic seat sound and the indicator will flash. If front seat, something may be
belt tensioners. your seat belt is not fastened before interfering with the monitoring
This system uses the same sensors the beeper stops, the indicator will system. Look for and remove:
as the front airbags to monitor stop flashing but remain on.
whether the front seat belts are Any items under the front
latched or unlatched, and how much If a front passenger does not fasten passenger’s seat.
weight is on the front passenger’s their seat belt, the indicator will
seat (see pages 22 and 25 ). come on about 6 seconds after the Any object(s) hanging on the seat
ignition switch is turned to the ON or in the seat-back pocket.
The seat belt system (II) position.
includes an indicator on the Any object(s) touching the rear of
instrument panel and a beeper to If either the driver or a front the seat-back.
remind you and your passengers to passenger does not fasten their seat
fasten your seat belts. belt while driving, the beeper will If no obstructions are found, have
sound and the indicator will flash your vehicle checked by a dealer.
again at regular intervals.

When no one is sitting in the front


passenger’s seat, or a child or small
adult is riding there, the indicator
should not come on and the beeper
should not sound.

18
07/07/11 15:09:43 31SVA620 0024 

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Lap/Shoulder Belt All seat belts have an emergency Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The lap and shoulder belt goes over locking retractor. In normal driving,
your shoulder, across your chest, the retractor lets you move freely in
and across your hips. your seat while it keeps some

Driver and Passenger Safety


tension on the belt. During a collision
To fasten the belt, insert the latch or sudden stop, the retractor
plate into the buckle, then tug on the automatically locks the belt to help
belt to make sure the buckle is restrain your body.
latched (see page 14 for how to
properly position the belt). In addition, the lap/shoulder belts in
all seating positions except the
To unlock the belt, press the red driver’s have a lockable retractor
PRESS button on the buckle. Guide that must be activated to secure a
the belt across your body so that it child seat (see page 43 ).
retracts completely. After exiting the For added protection, the front seat
vehicle, be sure the belt is out of the If the shoulder part of the belt is belts are equipped with automatic
way and will not get closed in the pulled all the way out, the lockable seat belt tensioners. When activated,
door. retractor will activate. The belt will the tensioners immediately tighten
retract, but it will not allow the the belts to help hold the driver and
passenger to move freely. a front passenger in position.

To deactivate the lockable retractor,


unlatch the buckle and let the seat
belt fully retract. To refasten the
seat belt, pull it out only as far as
needed. CONTINUED

19
07/07/11 15:09:50 31SVA620 0025 

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

The tensioners are designed to Seat Belt Maintenance If a seat belt is worn during a crash,
activate in any collision severe For safety, you should check the it must be replaced by your dealer. A
enough to cause the front airbags to condition of your seat belts regularly. belt that has been worn during a
deploy. crash may not provide the same level
Pull each belt out fully, and look for of protection in a subsequent crash.
If a side airbag or side curtain airbag frays, cuts, burns, and wear. Check
deploys during a side impact, the that the latches work smoothly and The dealer should also inspect the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle the belts retract easily. If a belt does anchors for damage and replace
will also deploy. not retract easily, cleaning the belt them if needed. If the automatic seat
may correct the problem (see page belt tensioners activate during a
The tensioners can also be activated 251 ). Any belt that is not in good crash, they must be replaced.
during a collision in which the front condition or working properly will
airbags do not deploy. In this case, the not provide good protection and
airbags would not be needed, but the should be replaced as soon as
additional restraint could be helpful. possible. Not checking or maintaining
seat belts can result in serious
When the tensioners are activated, Honda provides a limited warranty injury or death if the seat belts
the seat belts will remain tight until on seat belts. See your Honda do not work properly when
they are unbuckled. Warranty Information booklet for needed.
details.
Check your seat belts regularly
and have any problem
corrected as soon as possible.

20
07/07/11 15:09:57 31SVA620 0026 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Airbag System Components

(8) (12) (8) (9) (17) (2) (13) (17)

Driver and Passenger Safety


(11)
(5)
(10)

(1) Driver’s Airbag (1) (4)


(2) Front Passenger’s Airbag
(3) Control Unit
(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners
(5) Side Airbags (3)
(6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor
(7) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors
(8) Front Impact Sensors
(9) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
(10) Side Impact Sensors (First)
(7) (16)
(11) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors
(12) SRS Indicator (15)
(13) Occupant Detection System (ODS) Unit
(14) Front Seat Belt Buckle Tensioners (10)
(15) Rear Safing Sensor (6)
(16) Side Impact Sensors (Second) (5) (16) (4) (14)
(17) Side Curtain Airbags

CONTINUED
21
07/07/11 15:10:07 31SVA620 0027 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Your airbag system includes: Sensors that can detect a Weight sensors that monitor the
Two SRS (supplemental restraint moderate to severe front impact or weight on the front passenger’s
system) front airbags. The driver’s side impact. seat. If the weight is about 65 lbs
airbag is stored in the center of (29 kg) or less (the weight of an
the steering wheel; the front Sensors that can detect whether a infant or small child), the
passenger’s airbag is stored in the child is in the passenger’s side passenger’s front airbag will be
dashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRS airbag path and signal the control turned off (see page 25 ).
AIRBAG’’ (see page 23 ). unit to turn the airbag off (see
page 27 ). A sophisticated electronic system
Two side airbags, one for the that continually monitors and
driver and one for a front Sensors that can detect whether records information about the
passenger. The airbags are stored the driver’s seat belt and the front sensors, the control unit, the
in the outer edges of the seat- passenger’s seat belt are latched airbag activators, the seat belt
backs. Both are marked ‘‘SIDE or unlatched (see page 18 ). tensioners, and driver and front
AIRBAG’’ (see page 26 ). passenger seat belt use when the
A driver’s seat position sensor that ignition switch is in the ON (II)
Two side curtain airbags, one for monitors the distance of the seat position.
each side of the vehicle. The from the front airbag. If the seat is
airbags are stored in the ceiling, too far forward, the airbag will An indicator on the instrument
above the side windows. The front inflate with less force (see page panel that alerts you to a possible
and rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDE 25 ). problem with your airbags,
CURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page sensors, or seat belt tensioners
28 ). (see page 28 ).

Automatic front seat belt


tensioners (see page 19 ).

22
07/07/11 15:10:16 31SVA620 0028 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

An indicator on the instrument How Your Front Airbags Work During a frontal crash, your seat belt
panel that alerts you that the restrains your lower body and torso,
passenger’s side airbag has been and the front airbag helps protect
turned off (see page 29 ). your head and chest.

Driver and Passenger Safety


An indicator on the dashboard that Although both airbags normally
alerts you that the passenger’s inflate within split second of each
front airbag has been turned off other, it is possible for only one
(see page 29 ). airbag to deploy.

Emergency backup power in case This can happen if the severity of a


your vehicle’s electrical system is collision is at the margin, or
disconnected in a crash. threshold, that determines whether
or not the airbags will deploy. In
If you ever have a moderate to such cases, the seat belt will provide
severe frontal collision, sensors will sufficient protection, and the
detect the vehicle’s rapid supplemental protection offered by
deceleration. the airbag would be minimal.

If the rate of deceleration is high Only the driver’s airbag will deploy if
enough, the control unit will instantly there is no passenger in the front
inflate the driver’s and front seat, or if the advanced airbag
passenger’s airbags, at the time and system has turned the passenger’s
with the force needed. airbag off (see page 25 ).

CONTINUED

23
07/07/11 15:10:24 31SVA620 0029 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

After a crash, you may see what Dual-Threshold Airbags


looks like smoke. This is actually Your front airbags are also dual-
powder from the airbag’s surface. threshold airbags. Airbags with this
Although the powder is not harmful, feature have two deployment
people with respiratory problems thresholds that depend on whether
may experience some temporary sensors detect the occupant is
discomfort. If this occurs, get out of wearing a seat belt or not.
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do
so. If the occupant’s belt is not latched,
the airbag will deploy at a slightly
Dual-Stage Airbags lower threshold, because the
Your front airbags are dual-stage occupant would need extra
airbags. This means they have two protection.
inflation stages that can be ignited
After inflating, the front airbags sequentially or simultaneously, If the occupant’s belt is latched, the
immediately deflate, so they won’t depending on crash severity. airbag will inflate at a slightly higher
interfere with the driver’s visibility, threshold, when the airbag would be
or the ability to steer or operate In a more severe crash, both stages needed to supplement the protection
other controls. will ignite simultaneously to provide provided by the seat belt.
the quickest and greatest protection.
The total time for inflation and
deflation is one-tenth of a second, so In a less severe crash, one stage will
fast that most occupants are not ignite first, then the second stage
aware that the airbags deployed until will ignite a split second later. This
they see them lying in their laps. provides longer airbag inflation time
with a little less force.

24
07/07/11 15:10:33 31SVA620 0030 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Advanced Airbags
Your front airbags are also advanced
airbags. The main purpose of this
feature is to help prevent airbag-

Driver and Passenger Safety


caused injuries to short drivers and
children who ride in front.

For both advanced airbags to work


properly: DRIVER’S PASSENGER’S
SEAT SEAT WEIGHT
POSITION SENSORS
Occupants must sit upright and SENSOR
wear their seat belts properly.

Do not spill any liquids on or The driver’s advanced front airbag The passenger’s advanced front
under the seats, cover the sensors, system includes a seat position airbag system has weight sensors
or put any objects or metal items sensor under the seat. If the seat is under the seat. Although Honda
under the front seats. too far forward, the airbag will does not encourage carrying an
inflate with less force, regardless of infant or small child in front, if the
Back-seat passengers should not the severity of the impact. sensors detect the weight of an
put their feet under the front seats. infant or small child (up to about 65
If there is a problem with the sensor, lbs or 29 kg), the system will
Failure to follow these instructions the SRS indicator will come on, and automatically turn the passenger’s
could damage the sensors or prevent the airbag will inflate in the normal front airbag off.
them from working properly. manner regardless of the driver’s
seating position.
CONTINUED

25
07/10/30 14:11:45 31SVA620 0031 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Be aware that objects placed on Moving the front seat forcibly How Your Side Airbags Work
the passenger’s seat can also back against cargo on the seat or
cause the airbag to be turned off. floor behind it.

When the airbag is turned off, a Moving the front seat or seat-back
‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator in forcibly back against the folded
the center of the dashboard comes rear seat.
on (see page 29 ).
Hanging heavy items on the front
If the weight sensors detect there is passenger seat, or placing heavy
no passenger in the front seat, the items in the seat-back pocket.
airbag will be off. However, the
passenger airbag off indicator will If your vehicle is equipped with
not come on. the floor mats, make sure the floor
mat behind the front passenger’s If you ever have a moderate to
To ensure that the passenger’s seat is positioned properly (see severe side impact, sensors will
advanced front airbag system will page 252 ). If it is not, the mat may detect rapid acceleration and signal
work properly, do not do anything interfere with the proper operation the control unit to instantly inflate
that would increase or decrease the of the sensors and operation of the either the driver’s or the passenger’s
weight on the front passenger’s seat. seat. side airbag.
This includes:

A rear passenger pushing or


pulling on the back of the front
passenger’s seat.

26
07/07/11 15:10:49 31SVA620 0032 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Only one airbag will deploy during a Side Airbag Cutoff System If the side airbag off indicator comes
side impact. If the impact is on the Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoff on (see page 29 ), have the
passenger’s side, the passenger’s system designed primarily to protect passenger sit upright. Once the
side airbag will deploy even if there a child riding in the front passenger’s passenger is out of the airbag’s

Driver and Passenger Safety


is no passenger. seat. deployment path, the system will
turn the airbag back on, and the
To get the best protection from the Although Honda does not encourage indicator will go out.
side airbags, front seat occupants children to ride in front, if position
should wear their seat belts and sit sensors detect a child has leaned into There will be some delay between
upright and well back in their seats. the side airbag’s deployment path, the moment the passenger moves
the airbag will shut off. into or out of the airbag deployment
path and when the indicator comes
The side airbag may also shut off if a on or goes off.
short adult leans sideways, or a
larger adult slouches and leans A front seat passenger should not
sideways into the airbag’s use a cushion or other object as a
deployment path. backrest. It may prevent the cutoff
system from working properly.
Objects placed on the front
passenger seat can also cause the
side airbag to be shut off.

27
07/07/24 19:15:21 31SVA620 0033 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

How Your Side Curtain Airbags If the impact is on the passenger’s How the SRS Indicator Works
Work side, the passenger’s side curtain The SRS indicator alerts
airbag will inflate even if there are no you to a potential problem
occupants on that side of the vehicle. with your airbags or seat belt
tensioners.
To get the best protection from the
side curtain airbags, occupants When you turn the ignition switch to
should wear their seat belts and sit the ON (II) position, this indicator
upright and well back in their seats. comes on briefly then goes off. This
tells you the system is working
properly.

If the indicator comes on at any


SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG other time, or does not come on at all,
you should have the system checked
In a moderate to severe side impact, by your dealer. For example:
sensors will detect rapid acceleration
and signal the control unit to If the SRS indicator does not come
instantly inflate the side curtain on after you turn the ignition
airbag and activate the seat belt switch to the ON (II) position.
tensioner on the driver’s or the
passenger’s side of the vehicle. If the indicator stays on after the
engine starts.

If the indicator comes on or


flashes on and off while you drive.

28
07/07/11 15:11:08 31SVA620 0034 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

If you see any of these indications, How the Side Airbag Off How the Passenger Airbag Off
the airbags and seat belt tensioners Indicator Works Indicator Works
may not work properly when you U.S. Canada
need them. PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR

Driver and Passenger Safety


This indicator alerts you that the U.S.
passenger’s side airbag has been
Ignoring the SRS indicator can automatically shut off. It does not
result in serious injury or death mean there is a problem with your
if the airbag systems or side airbags.
Canada
tensioners do not work properly.
When you turn the ignition switch to
Have your vehicle checked by a the ON (II) position, the indicator
dealer as soon as possible if should come on briefly and then go
the SRS indicator alerts you to off (see page 58 ). If it doesn’t come
a possible problem. on, stays on, or comes on while This indicator alerts you that the
driving without a passenger in the passenger’s front airbag has been
front seat, have the system checked. shut off because weight sensors
detect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less
(the weight of an infant or small
child) on the front passenger’s seat.
It does not mean there is a problem
with the airbag.

CONTINUED

29
07/07/11 15:11:18 31SVA620 0035 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Be aware that objects placed on the If the indicator comes on with no Airbag Service
front seat can cause the indicator to front seat passenger and no objects Your airbag systems are virtually
come on. on the seat, or with an adult riding maintenance free, and there are no
there, something may be interfering parts you can safely service.
If no weight is detected on the front with the weight sensors. Look for However, you must have your
seat, the airbag will be automatically and remove: vehicle serviced if:
shut off. However, the indicator will
not come on. Any items under the front An airbag ever inflates. Any airbag
passenger’s seat. that has deployed must be
The passenger airbag off indicator replaced along with the control
may come on and off repeatedly if Any object(s) hanging on the seat unit and other related parts. Any
the total weight on the seat is near or in the seat-back pocket. seat belt tensioner that activates
the airbag cutoff threshold. must also be replaced.
Any object(s) touching the rear of
If an adult or teenage passenger is the seat-back. Do not try to remove or replace
riding in front, move the seat as far any airbag by yourself. This must
to the rear as possible, and have the If no obstructions are found, have be done by an authorized dealer or
passenger sit upright and wear the your vehicle checked by a dealer as a knowledgeable body shop.
seat belt properly. soon as possible.
The SRS indicator alerts you to a
problem. Take your vehicle to an
authorized dealer as soon as
possible. If you ignore this
indication, your airbags may not
operate properly.

30
07/07/11 15:11:24 31SVA620 0036 

Additional Information About Your Airbags

If your vehicle has a moderate to Additional Safety Precautions Do not cover or replace front seat-
severe impact. Even if your Do not attempt to deactivate your back covers without consulting
airbags do not inflate, your dealer airbags. Together, airbags and your dealer. Improperly replacing
should inspect the driver’s seat seat belts provide the best or covering front seat-back covers

Driver and Passenger Safety


position sensor and the front protection. can prevent your side airbags from
passenger’s weight sensors to inflating during a side impact.
make sure they are operating Do not tamper with airbag
properly. components or wiring for any Do not expose the front passenger’s
reason. Tampering could cause seat-back to liquid. If water or
the airbags to deploy, possibly another liquid soaks into the seat-
causing very serious injury. back, it can prevent the side airbag
cutoff system from working
Do not remove or modify a front properly.
seat without consulting your
dealer. This could make the
driver’s seat position sensor or the
front passenger’s weight sensors
ineffective. If it is necessary to
remove or modify a front seat to
accommodate a person with
disabilities, first contact Honda
Automobile Customer Service at
(800) 999-1009.

31
07/07/11 15:11:32 31SVA620 0037 

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

All Children Must Be Restrained


Each year, many children are injured
or killed in vehicle crashes because Children who are unrestrained
they are either unrestrained or not or improperly restrained can be
properly restrained. In fact, vehicle seriously injured or killed in a
accidents are the number one cause crash.
of the death of children ages 12 and
under. Any child too small for a seat
belt should be properly
To reduce the number of child restrained in a child seat. A
deaths and injuries, every state and larger child should be properly
Canadian province requires that restrained with a seat belt and
infants and children be properly use a booster seat if necessary.
Children depend on adults to protect restrained when they ride in a
them. However, despite their best vehicle.
intentions, many adults do not know Larger children must be restrained
how to properly protect child Infants and small children must be with a lap/shoulder belt and ride on
passengers. restrained in an approved child seat a booster seat until the seat belt fits
that is properly secured to the them properly (see pages 46 − 49 ).
If you have children, or ever need to vehicle (see pages 37 − 45 ).
drive with a child in your vehicle, be
sure to read this section. It begins
with important general guidelines,
then presents special information for
infants, small children, and larger
children.

32
07/07/11 15:11:42 31SVA620 0038 

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

All Children Should Sit in a Back The Passenger’s Front Airbag Small Children
Seat Can Pose Serious Risks Placing a forward-facing child seat in
According to accident statistics, Front airbags have been designed to the front seat of a vehicle equipped
children of all ages and sizes are help protect adults in a moderate to with a passenger’s front airbag can

Driver and Passenger Safety


safer when they are restrained in a severe frontal collision. To do this, be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is
back seat. the passenger’s front airbag is quite too far forward, or the child’s head is
large, and it can inflate with enough thrown forward during a collision, an
The National Highway Traffic Safety force to cause very serious injuries. inflating front airbag can strike the
Administration and Transport child with enough force to kill or
Canada recommend that all children Even though your vehicle has an very seriously injure a small child.
age 12 and under be properly advanced front airbag system that
restrained in a back seat. Some automatically turns the passenger’s Larger Children
states have laws restricting where front airbag off (see page 25 ), Children who have outgrown child
children may ride. please follow these guidelines: seats are also at risk of being injured
or killed by an inflating passenger’s
Children who ride in back are less Infants front airbag. Whenever possible,
likely to be injured by striking Never put a rear-facing child seat in larger children should sit in the back
interior vehicle parts during a the front seat of a vehicle equipped seat, on a booster seat if needed, and
collision or hard braking. Also, with a passenger’s front airbag. If be properly restrained with a seat
children cannot be injured by an the airbag inflates, it can hit the back belt (see page 46 for important
inflating front airbag when they ride of the child seat with enough force information about protecting larger
in the back. to kill or very seriously injure an children).
infant.

CONTINUED

33
07/07/11 15:11:54 31SVA620 0039 

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

To remind you of the passenger’s U.S. Models DASHBOARD


front airbag hazards, and that SUN VISOR
children must be properly restrained
in a back seat, your vehicle has
warning labels on the dashboard
(U.S. models) and on the front visors.
Please read and follow the
instructions on these labels.

Canadian Models
SUN VISOR

34
07/07/11 15:12:05 31SVA620 0040 

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

If You Must Drive with Several If a Child Requires Close Additional Safety Precautions
Children Attention Never hold an infant or child on
Your vehicle has a back seat where Many parents say they prefer to put your lap. If you are not wearing a
children can be properly restrained. an infant or a small child in the front seat belt in a crash, you could be

Driver and Passenger Safety


If you ever have to carry a group of passenger seat so they can watch the thrown forward and crush the
children, and a child must ride in child, or because the child requires child against the dashboard or a
front: attention. seat-back. If you are wearing a
seat belt, the child can be torn
Place the largest child in the front Placing a child in the front seat from your arms and be seriously
seat, provided the child is large exposes the child to hazards in a hurt or killed.
enough to wear the lap/shoulder frontal collision, and paying close
belt properly (see page 46 ). attention to a child distracts the Never put a seat belt over yourself
driver from the important tasks of and a child. During a crash, the
Move the vehicle seat as far to the driving, placing both of you at risk. belt could press deep into the child
rear as possible (see page 92 ). and cause serious or fatal injuries.
If a child requires close physical
Have the child sit upright and well attention or frequent visual contact, Never let two children use the
back in the seat (see page 15 ). we strongly recommend that another same seat belt. If they do, they
adult ride with the child in the back could be very seriously injured in a
Make sure the seat belt is properly seat. The back seat is far safer for a crash.
positioned and secured (see page child than the front.
14 ).

CONTINUED

35
07/07/11 15:12:10 31SVA620 0041 

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

Make sure any unused seat belt Lock both doors and the trunk
that a child can reach is buckled, when your vehicle is not in use.
the lockable retractor is activated, Children who play in vehicles can
and the belt is fully retracted and accidentally get trapped inside.
locked. If a child wraps a loose Teach your children not to play in
seat belt around their neck, they or around vehicles. Know how to
can be seriously or fatally injured. operate the emergency trunk
(See pages 43 and 44 for how to opener and decide if your children
activate and deactivate the should be shown how to use this
lockable retractor.) feature (see page 91 ).

Do not leave children alone in a Keep vehicle keys/remote


vehicle. Leaving children without transmitters out of the reach of
adult supervision is illegal in most children. Even very young
states and Canadian provinces, children learn how to unlock
and can be very hazardous. vehicle doors, turn on the ignition
switch, and open the trunk, which
For example, infants and small can lead to accidental injury or
children left in a vehicle on a hot death.
day can die from heatstroke. A
child left alone with the key in the
ignition switch can accidentally set
the vehicle in motion, possibly
injuring themselves or others.

36
07/07/11 15:12:19 31SVA620 0042 

Protecting Infants and Small Children

Protecting Infants Two types of seats may be used: a Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
seat designed exclusively for infants, A rear-facing child seat can be placed
or a convertible seat used in the rear- in any seating position in the back
facing, reclining mode. seat, but not in the front. Never put a

Driver and Passenger Safety


rear-facing child seat in the front
Do not put a rear-facing child seat in seat.
a forward-facing position. If placed
facing forward, an infant could be If the passenger’s front airbag
very seriously injured during a inflates, it can hit the back of the
frontal collision. child seat with enough force to kill or
seriously injure an infant.

When properly installed, a rear-


facing child seat may prevent the
Child Seat Type driver or a front passenger from
An infant must be properly moving their seat as far back as
restrained in a rear-facing, reclining recommended, or from locking their
child seat until the child reaches the seat-back in the desired position.
seat maker’s weight or height limit
for the seat, and the child is at least It can also interfere with proper
one year old. operation of the passenger’s
advanced front airbag system.
Only a rear-facing child seat provides
proper support for a baby’s head,
neck, and back.
CONTINUED

37
07/07/11 15:12:28 31SVA620 0043 

Protecting Infants and Small Children

In any of these situations, we Protecting Small Children We also recommend that a small
strongly recommend that you install child use the child seat until the child
the child seat directly behind the reaches the weight or height limit
front passenger’s seat, move the seat for the seat.
as far forward as needed, and leave it
unoccupied. Or, you may wish to get Child Seat Placement
a smaller rear-facing child seat. We strongly recommend placing a
forward-facing child seat in a back
seat, not the front.

Placing a rear-facing child seat Placing a forward-facing child seat in


in the front seat can result in the front seat of a vehicle equipped
serious injury or death during a with a passenger’s airbag can be
collision. hazardous. If the vehicle seat is too
far forward, or the child’s head is
Always place a rear-facing child Child Seat Type thrown forward during a collision, an
seat in the back seat, not the A child who is at least one year old, inflating airbag can strike the child
front. and who fits within the child seat with enough force to cause very
maker’s weight and height limits, serious or fatal injuries.
should be restrained in a forward-
facing, upright child seat. Even with advanced front airbags
that automatically turn the
Of the different seats available, we passenger’s front airbag off (see
recommend those that have a five- page 25 ), a back seat is the safest
point harness system as shown. place for a small child.

38
07/07/11 15:12:36 31SVA620 0044 

Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat

If it is necessary to put a forward- Selecting a Child Seat In seating positions and vehicles not
facing child seat in the front, move When buying a child seat, you need equipped with LATCH, a LATCH-
the vehicle seat as far to the rear as to choose either a conventional child compatible child seat can be installed
possible, and be sure the child seat is seat, or one designed for use with using a seat belt.

Driver and Passenger Safety


firmly secured to the vehicle and the the lower anchors and tethers for
child is properly strapped in the seat. children (LATCH) system. Whatever type of seat you choose, to
provide proper protection, a child
Conventional child seats must be seat should meet three
secured to a vehicle with a seat belt, requirements:
Placing a forward-facing child whereas LATCH-compatible seats
seat in the front seat can result are secured by attaching the seat to 1. The child seat should meet U.S. or
in serious injury or death if the hardware built into the two outer Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
front airbag inflates. seating positions in the back seat. Standard 213. Look for FMVSS
213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
If you must place a forward- Since LATCH-compatible child seats
facing child seat in front, move are easier to install and reduce the 2. The child seat should be of the
the vehicle seat as far back as possibility of improper installation, proper type and size to fit the child.
possible, and properly restrain we recommend selecting this style. Rear-facing for infants, forward-
the child. facing for small children.

CONTINUED

39
07/07/11 15:12:44 31SVA620 0045 

Selecting a Child Seat, Installing a Child Seat

3. The child seat should fit the Installing a Child Seat movement can be expected and
vehicle seating position (or After selecting a proper child seat should not reduce the child seat’s
positions) where it will be used. and a good place to install the seat, effectiveness.
there are three main steps in
Before purchasing a conventional installing the seat: If the child seat is not secure, try
child seat, or using a previously installing it in a different seating
purchased one, we recommend that 1. Properly secure the child seat to position, or use a different style of
you test the seat in the specific the vehicle. All child seats must be child seat that can be firmly secured.
vehicle seating position or positions secured to the vehicle with the lap
where the seat will be used. part of a lap/shoulder belt or with 3. Secure the child in the child seat.
the LATCH (lower anchors and Make sure the child is properly
tethers for children) system. A strapped in the child seat
child whose seat is not properly according to the child seat maker’s
secured to the vehicle can be instructions. A child who is not
endangered in a crash. properly secured in a child seat
can be seriously injured in a crash.
2. Make sure the child seat is firmly
secured. After installing a child The following pages provide
seat, push and pull the seat guidelines on how to properly install
forward and from side-to-side to a child seat. A forward-facing child
verify that it is secure. seat is used in all examples, but the
instructions are the same for rear-
A child seat secured with a seat belt facing child seats.
should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, it does not need
to be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-side

40
07/07/11 15:12:53 31SVA620 0046 

Installing a Child Seat

Installing a Child Seat with BUTTONS


LATCH
Your vehicle is equipped with
LATCH (lower anchors and tethers

Driver and Passenger Safety


for children) at the outer rear seats.

The lower anchors are located


between the seat-back and seat
bottom, and are to be used only with
a child seat designed for use with
LATCH.
LOWER ANCHORS Rigid type
The location of each lower anchor is
indicated by a small button above the To install a LATCH-compatible child 3. Place the child seat on the vehicle
anchor point. seat: seat, then attach the seat to the
lower anchors according to the
1. Move the seat belt buckle or child seat maker’s instructions.
tongue away from the lower
anchors. Some LATCH-compatible seats
have a rigid-type connector as
2. Make sure there are no objects shown above.
near the anchors that could
prevent a secure connection
between the child seat and the
anchors.
CONTINUED

41
07/07/11 15:13:00 31SVA620 0047 

Installing a Child Seat

TETHER STRAP HOOK 6. Attach the tether strap hook to the


tether anchor, then tighten the
strap as instructed by the child
seat maker.

7. Push and pull the child seat


forward and from side-to-side to
verify that it is secure.

Flexible type ANCHOR

Other LATCH-compatible seats 5. Adjust the head restraint to its


have a flexible-type connector as lowest position. Route the tether
shown above. strap over the head restraint,
making sure the strap is not
4. Whatever type you have, follow twisted.
the child seat maker’s instructions
for adjusting or tightening the fit.

42
07/07/11 15:13:08 31SVA620 0048 

Installing a Child Seat

Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/


Shoulder Belt
When not using the LATCH system,
all child seats must be secured to the

Driver and Passenger Safety


vehicle with the lap part of a lap/
shoulder belt.

In addition, the lap/shoulder belts in


all seating positions except the
driver’s have a lockable retractor
that must be activated to secure a
child seat.

1. With the child seat in the desired 2. To activate the lockable retractor,
seating position, route the belt slowly pull the shoulder part of the
through the child seat according belt all the way out until it stops,
to the seat maker’s instructions, then let the belt feed back into the
then insert the latch plate into the retractor.
buckle.
3. After the belt has retracted, tug on
it. If the belt is locked, you will not
be able to pull it out. If you can pull
the belt out, it is not locked, and
you will need to repeat these steps.

CONTINUED

43
07/07/11 15:13:14 31SVA620 0049 

Installing a Child Seat

To deactivate the lockable retractor


and remove a child seat, unlatch the
buckle, unroute the seat belt, and let
the belt fully retract.

4. After confirming that the belt is 5. Push and pull the child seat
locked, grab the shoulder part of forward and from side-to-side to
the belt near the buckle, and pull verify that it is secure enough to
up to remove any slack from the stay upright during normal driving
lap part of the belt. Remember, if maneuvers. If the child seat is not
the lap part of the belt is not tight, secure, unlatch the belt, allow it to
the child seat will not be secure. retract fully, then repeat these
steps.
To remove slack, it may help to
put weight on the child seat, or
push on the back of the seat while
pulling up on the belt.

44
07/07/11 15:13:23 31SVA620 0050 

Installing a Child Seat

Installing a Child Seat with a Using an Anchor


Tether
Front Front
TETHER ANCHORAGE POINTS

Driver and Passenger Safety


TETHER STRAP
HOOK
TETHER
STRAP
HOOK

ANCHOR ANCHOR
Outer position Center position
ANCHOR COVER
1. After properly securing the child 3. Tighten the strap according to the
A child seat with a tether can be seat (see page 43 ), adjust the seat maker’s instructions.
installed in any seating position in head restraint to its lowest
the back seat, using one of the position, then route the tether
anchorage points shown above. strap over the head restraint.

Since a tether can provide additional 2. Lift the anchor cover, then attach
security to the lap/shoulder belt the tether strap hook to the
installation, we recommend using a anchor, making sure the strap is
tether whenever one is required or not twisted.
available.

45
07/07/11 15:13:30 31SVA620 0051 

Protecting Larger Children

When a child reaches the Checking Seat Belt Fit


recommended weight or height limit
for a forward-facing child seat, the Allowing a child age 12 or under
child should sit in a back seat on a to sit in front can result in injury
booster seat and wear a lap/shoulder or death if the passenger’s front
belt. airbag inflates.

The following pages give If a child must ride in front,


instructions on how to check proper move the vehicle seat as far
seat belt fit, what kind of booster back as possible, use a booster
seat to use if one is needed, and seat if needed, have the child
important precautions for a child sit up properly and wear the
who must sit in front. seat belt properly.

To determine if a lap/shoulder belt


properly fits a child, have the child
put on the seat belt, then ask
yourself:

1. Does the child sit all the way back


against the seat?

2. Do the child’s knees bend


comfortably over the edge of the
seat?

46
07/07/11 15:13:38 31SVA620 0052 

Protecting Larger Children

3. Does the shoulder belt cross Using a Booster Seat Some states and Canadian provinces
between the child’s neck and arm? also require children to use a booster
seat until they reach a given age or
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as weight (e.g., 6 years or 60 lbs). Be

Driver and Passenger Safety


possible, touching the child’s sure to check current laws in the
thighs? states or provinces where you intend
to drive.
5. Will the child be able to stay
seated like this for the whole trip? Booster seats can be high-back or
low-back. Whichever style you select,
If you answer yes to all these make sure the booster seat meets
questions, the child is ready to wear federal safety standards (see page
the lap/shoulder belt correctly. If 39 ) and that you follow the booster
you answer no to any question, the seat maker’s instructions.
child needs to ride on a booster seat. A child who has outgrown a forward-
facing child seat should ride in a If a child who uses a booster seat
back seat and use a booster seat must ride in front, move the vehicle
until the lap/shoulder belt fits them seat as far back as possible, and be
properly without the booster. sure the child is wearing the seat
belt properly.

CONTINUED

47
07/07/11 15:13:46 31SVA620 0053 

Protecting Larger Children

A child may continue using a booster When Can a Larger Child Sit in Of course, children vary widely. And
seat until the tops of their ears are Front while age may be one indicator of
even with the top of the vehicle’s or The National Highway Traffic Safety when a child can safely ride in front,
booster’s seat-back. A child of this Administration and Transport there are other important factors you
height should be tall enough to use Canada recommend that all children should consider.
the lap/shoulder belt without a age 12 and under be properly
booster seat. restrained in the back seat. Physical Size
Physically, a child must be large
If the passenger’s front airbag enough for the lap/shoulder belt to
inflates in a moderate to severe properly fit (see pages 14 and 46 ). If
frontal collision, the airbag can cause the seat belt does not fit properly,
serious injuries to a child who is with or without the child sitting on a
unrestrained, improperly restrained, booster seat, the child should not sit
sitting too close to the airbag, or out in front.
of position.
Maturity
A side airbag also poses risks. If any To safely ride in front, a child must
part of a larger child’s body is in the be able to follow the rules, including
path of a deploying side airbag, the sitting properly, and wearing the seat
child could receive possibly serious belt properly throughout a ride.
injuries.

48
07/07/11 15:13:54 31SVA620 0054 

Protecting Larger Children

If you decide that a child can safely Additional Safety Precautions Do not put any accessories on a
ride up front, be sure to: Do not let a child wear a seat belt seat belt. Devices intended to
across the neck. This could result improve a child’s comfort or
Carefully read the owner’s manual, in serious neck injuries during a reposition the shoulder part of a

Driver and Passenger Safety


and make sure you understand all crash. seat belt can make the belt less
seat belt instructions and all safety effective and increase the chance
information. Do not let a child put the shoulder of serious injury in a crash.
part of a seat belt behind the back
Move the vehicle seat to the rear- or under the arm. This could
most position. cause very serious injuries during
a crash. It also increases the
Have the child sit up straight, back chance that the child will slide
against the seat, and feet on or under the belt in a crash and be
near the floor. injured.

Check that the child’s seat belt is Two children should never use the
properly and securely positioned. same seat belt. If they do, they
could be very seriously injured in a
Supervise the child. Even mature crash.
children sometimes need to be
reminded to fasten the seat belts
or sit properly.

49
07/07/11 15:14:02 31SVA620 0055 

Carbon Monoxide Hazard

Your vehicle’s exhaust contains With the trunk open, airflow can pull
carbon monoxide gas. Carbon exhaust gas into your vehicle’s
monoxide should not enter the Carbon monoxide gas is toxic. interior and create a hazardous
vehicle in normal driving if you Breathing it can cause condition. If you must drive with the
maintain your vehicle properly and unconsciousness and even kill trunk open, open all the windows and
follow the information on this page. you. set the heating and cooling system
as shown below.
Have the exhaust system inspected Avoid any enclosed areas or
for leaks whenever: activities that expose you to If you must sit in your parked vehicle
carbon monoxide. with the engine running, even in an
The vehicle is raised for an oil unconfined area, adjust the heating
change. and cooling system as follows:
High levels of carbon monoxide can
You notice a change in the sound collect rapidly in enclosed areas, 1. Select the fresh air mode.
of the exhaust. such as a garage. Do not run the 2. Select the mode.
engine with the garage door closed. 3. Turn the fan on high speed.
The vehicle was in an accident Even with the door open, run the 4. Set the temperature control to a
that may have damaged the engine only long enough to move the comfortable setting.
underside. vehicle out of the garage.

50
07/07/11 15:14:16 31SVA620 0056 

Safety Labels

These labels are in the locations DASHBOARD SUN VISOR


shown. They warn you of potential U.S. models only U.S. models
hazards that could cause serious
injury or death. Read these labels

Driver and Passenger Safety


carefully.

If a label comes off or becomes hard


to read (except for the U.S.
dashboard label which may be
removed by the owner), contact your
dealer for a replacement.
RADIATOR CAP

Canadian models

CONTINUED

51
07/07/11 15:14:28 31SVA620 0057 

Safety Labels

HOOD DOORJAMBS
U.S. models U.S. models Canadian models

Canadian models

52
07/07/11 15:14:32 31SVA620 0058 

Instruments and Controls

This section gives information about Control Locations ............................ 54 Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.. 81
the controls and displays that Instrument Panel ............................. 55 Remote Transmitter ........................ 86
contribute to the daily operation of Instrument Panel Indicators ........... 57 Trunk................................................. 90
your vehicle. All the essential Gauges .............................................. 65 Emergency Trunk Opener ......... 91
controls are within easy reach. Display Change Button ............... 66 Seats .................................................. 92
Odometer ...................................... 66 Power Windows ............................. 100

Instruments and Controls


Trip Meter .................................... 66 Moonroof ........................................ 102
Outside Temperature Mirrors ............................................ 104
Indicator .................................... 67 Parking Brake ................................ 105
Fuel Gauge ................................... 68 Interior Convenience Items .......... 106
Temperature Gauge .................... 68 Beverage Holders ...................... 107
Check Fuel Cap Message ........... 68 Console Compartment .............. 107
Maintenance Minder ................... 69 Glove Box ................................... 107
Controls Near the Steering Coat Hook ................................... 108
Wheel ............................................ 70 Accessory Power Sockets......... 108
Windshield Wipers and Washers .. 71 Vanity Mirror ............................. 109
Turn Signal and Headlights............ 72 Sun Visor .................................... 110
Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 73 Interior Lights ................................ 111
Hazard Warning Button .................. 74 Ceiling Light ............................... 111
Rear Window Defogger .................. 74 Spotlights .................................... 111
Steering Wheel Adjustments ......... 75 Courtesy Light ........................... 112
Keys and Locks ................................ 76
Immobilizer System......................... 77
Ignition Switch ................................. 78
Door Locks ....................................... 79
Power Door Locks ....................... 80

53
07/07/11 15:14:39 31SVA620 0059 

Control Locations

MOONROOF SWITCH* (P.102)


INSTRUMENT PANEL
INDICATORS (P.55, 56)
GAUGES (P.65)

CLOCK*
(P.180)
MIRROR CONTROLS*
(P.104)

POWER DOOR LOCK AUDIO SYSTEM*


MASTER SWITCH* (P.119)
(P.80)

POWER WINDOW HEATING/


SWITCHES* COOLING*
(P.100) CONTROLS
(P.114)

HOOD RELEASE FUEL FILL DOOR/ ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS


HANDLE TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE (P.108)
(P.188) (P.187, 90)
A/T model is shown. HAZARD WARNING BUTTON (P.74)

*: If equipped
54
07/10/30 14:12:29 31SVA620 0060 

Instrument Panel

DX, DX-G (Canada), LX, EX, EX-L


SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR* (P.64)

Instruments and Controls


LOW FUEL
INDICATOR
(P.64)
SIDE AIRBAG LIGHTS ON HIGH BEAM SUPPLEMENTAL TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
DAYTIME OFF INDICATOR INDICATOR INDICATOR RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RUNNING SYSTEM (TPMS) INDICATOR (P.61)
(P.58) (P.63) (P.63) INDICATOR (P.58)
LIGHTS PARKING BRAKE AND
INDICATOR (P.63) BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR
CRUISE MAIN (P.58)
INDICATOR* (P.62)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.59)
INDICATOR* (P.62)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.59) SEAT BELT REMINDER
INDICATOR (P.57)
LOW OIL PRESSURE TRUNK-OPEN INDICATOR
INDICATOR (P.57, 281) (P.63)
CHARGING SYSTEM DOOR-OPEN INDICATOR
INDICATOR (P.57, 281) MAINTENANCE MINDER (P.63)
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (P.57, 282) INDICATOR (P.60, 225) LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR (P.61)
*: If equipped

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for Canadian models are noted in the text. CONTINUED
Canadian DX-G model with M/T has the electric power steering (EPS) indicator (see page 60) next to the immobilizer system indicator.
55
07/07/11 15:14:58 31SVA620 0061 

Instrument Panel

Si

SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.64) REV LIMIT INDICATOR (P.61)

HIGH BEAM INDICATOR


(P.63)
LOW FUEL
LIGHTS ON INDICATOR INDICATOR
(P.63) (P.64)
SIDE AIRBAG OFF
INDICATOR (P.58) SUPPLEMENTAL CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR (P.62)
RESTRAINT SYSTEM LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR
VSA ACTIVATION INDICATOR (P.58) (P.61)
INDICATOR* (P.62) PARKING BRAKE AND BRAKE
SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.58)
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHTS INDICATOR (P.63) ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.59)
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST SEAT BELT REMINDER
(VSA) SYSTEM INDICATOR* INDICATOR (P.57)
(P.62)
TRUNK-OPEN INDICATOR
ELECTRIC POWER STEERING (P.63)
(EPS) INDICATOR (P.60) DOOR-OPEN INDICATOR
LOW OIL PRESSURE (P.63)
INDICATOR (P.57, 281)
TIRE PRESSURE
CHARGING SYSTEM IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM MONITORING SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.57, 281) INDICATOR (P.59) CRUISE CONTROL (TPMS) INDICATOR (P.61)
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR (P.62)
INDICATOR LAMP MAINTENANCE MINDER
*: If equipped (P.57, 282) INDICATOR (P.60, 225)

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for Canadian models are noted in the text.
56
07/07/11 15:15:07 31SVA620 0062 

Instrument Panel Indicators

The instrument panel has many If your front passenger does not Charging System
indicators to give you important fasten their seat belt, the indicator Indicator
information about your vehicle. comes on about 6 seconds after the If this indicator comes on when the
ignition switch is turned to the ON engine is running, the battery is not
Seat Belt Reminder (II) position. being charged. For more information,
Indicator see page 281 .

Instruments and Controls


This indicator comes on when you If either of you do not fasten your
turn the ignition switch to the ON seat belt while driving, the beeper Low Oil Pressure
(II) position. It reminds you and your will sound and the indicator will flash Indicator
passengers to fasten your seat belts. again at regular intervals. For more The engine can be severely damaged
A beeper also sounds if you have not information, see page 18 . if this indicator flashes or stays on
fastened your seat belt. when the engine is running. For
more information, see page 281 .
If you turn the ignition switch to the
ON (II) position before fastening Malfunction Indicator
your seat belt, the beeper sounds Lamp
and the indicator flashes. If you do See page 282 .
not fasten your seat belt before the
beeper stops, the indicator stops
flashing but remains on.

57
07/07/11 15:15:16 31SVA620 0063 

Instrument Panel Indicators

U.S. Canada Supplemental Restraint U.S. Canada


System Indicator
This indicator comes on briefly when
Parking Brake and Brake System you turn the ignition switch to the Side Airbag Off Indicator
Indicator ON (II) position. If it comes on at This indicator comes on briefly when
This indicator has two functions: any other time, it indicates a you turn the ignition switch to the
potential problem with your front ON (II) position. If it comes on at
1. It comes on when you turn the airbags. This indicator will also alert any other time, it indicates that the
ignition switch to the ON (II) you to a potential problem with your passenger’s side airbag has
position. It is a reminder to check side airbags, passenger’s side airbag automatically shut off. For more
the parking brake. A beeper cutoff system, side curtain airbags, information, see page 29 .
sounds if you drive with the automatic seat belt tensioners,
parking brake not fully released. driver’s seat position sensor, or the
Driving with the parking brake not front passenger’s weight sensors.
fully released can damage the For more information, see page 28 .
brakes and tires.

2. If it stays on after you have fully


released the parking brake while
the engine is running, or if it
comes on while driving, there
could be a problem with the brake
system. For more information, see
page 283 .

58
07/07/11 15:15:23 31SVA620 0064 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Anti-lock Brake System Immobilizer System


(ABS) Indicator Indicator
This indicator normally comes on for This indicator comes on briefly when Turn Signal and Hazard Warning
a few seconds when you turn the you turn the ignition switch to the Indicators
ignition switch to the ON (II) ON (II) position. It will then go off if The left or right turn signal indicator
position. If it comes on at any other you have inserted a properly-coded blinks when you signal a lane change

Instruments and Controls


time, there is a problem with the ignition key. If it is not a properly- or turn. If an indicator does not blink
ABS. If this happens, have your coded key, the indicator will blink, or blinks rapidly, it usually means
vehicle checked at a dealer. With and the engine’s fuel system will be one of the turn signal bulbs is
this indicator on, your vehicle still disabled (see page 77 ). burned out (see pages 249 and 250 ).
has normal braking ability but no Replace the bulb as soon as possible,
anti-lock function. For more since other drivers cannot see that
information, see page 214 . you are signaling.

When you press the hazard warning


button, both turn signal indicators
and all turn signals on the outside of
the vehicle flash.

59
07/10/30 14:05:13 31SVA620 0065 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Electric Power Steering If you turn the steering wheel to the Maintenance Minder
(EPS) Indicator full left or right position repeatedly Indicator
Si and Canadian DX-G with manual while stopping or driving at very low This indicator comes on for a few
transmission models speed, you may feel slightly harder seconds when you turn the ignition
This indicator normally comes on steering due to overheating of the switch to the ON (II) position. It
when you turn the ignition switch to steering gearbox. reminds you that it is time to take
the ON (II) position and goes off your vehicle in for scheduled
after the engine starts. If it comes on Continuously driving under those maintenance. The maintenance main
at any other time, there is a problem conditions could damage the power items and sub items will be displayed
in the electric power steering system. steering system. in the information display. See page
If this happens, stop the vehicle in a 225 for more information on the
safe place, and turn off the engine. maintenance minder.
Reset the system by restarting the
engine. The indicator will not turn This indicator goes off when your
off immediately. If it does not go off dealer resets it after completing the
after driving a short distance, or required maintenance service.
comes back on again while driving,
take the vehicle to your dealer to
have it checked. With the indicator
on, the EPS may be off, making the
vehicle harder to steer.

60
07/07/11 15:15:40 31SVA620 0066 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Low Tire Pressure Tire Pressure Monitoring Rev Limit Indicator


Indicator System (TPMS) Indicator
U.S. models only U.S. models only REV LIMIT INDICATOR
This indicator normally comes on for This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn the a few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II) ignition switch to the ON (II)

Instruments and Controls


position. position.
If it comes on while driving, it
indicates that one or more of your If this indicator comes on and stays
vehicle’s tires are significantly low on at any other time, or if it does not
on pressure. come on when you turn the ignition
switch to the ON (II) position, there Si model only
If this happens, pull to the side of the is a problem with the TPMS. With This indicator shows you when the
road when it is safe, check which tire this indicator on, the low tire engine speed is near the tachometer’s
has lost the pressure, and determine pressure indicator will not come on red zone. When the engine speed
the cause. If it is because of a flat tire, when a tire loses pressure. Take the gets to near the red zone, the
replace the flat tire with the compact vehicle to your dealer to have the indicator blinks. If you exceed the
spare (see page 271 ), and have the system checked. maximum speed for the gear you are
flat tire repaired as soon as possible. in, the indicator stays on, and you
If two or more tires are underinflated, may feel the engine cut in and out
call a professional towing service due to the engine speed limiter (see
(see page 290 ). For more page 207 ).
information, see page 218 .
To protect the engine from damage,
never drive with the tachometer in
its red zone.

61
07/07/11 15:15:54 31SVA620 0067 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Cruise Main Indicator Vehicle Stability Assist VSA Activation Indicator


(VSA) System Indicator
If equipped If equipped If equipped
This indicator comes on when you This indicator normally comes on for This indicator has three functions:
turn on the cruise control system by a few seconds when you turn the
pressing the CRUISE button (see ignition switch to the ON (II) 1. It comes on as a reminder that you
page 182 ). position. have turned off the vehicle
stability assist (VSA) system.
Cruise Control Indicator If it comes on and stays on at any
other time, or if it does not come on 2. It flashes when VSA is active (see
If equipped when you turn the ignition switch to page 216 ).
This indicator comes on when you the ON (II) position, there is a
set the cruise control. See page problem with the VSA system. Take 3. It comes on along with the VSA
182 for information on operating the your vehicle to a dealer to have it system indicator if there is a
cruise control. checked. Without VSA, your vehicle problem with the VSA system.
still has normal driving ability, but
will not have VSA traction and This indicator normally comes on for
stability enhancement. See page a few seconds when you turn the
216 for more information on the ignition switch to the ON (II)
VSA system. position. See page 216 for more
information on the VSA system.

62
07/07/11 15:16:04 31SVA620 0068 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Daytime Running Lights Trunk-open Indicator Lights On Indicator


Indicator
If this indicator comes on when you This indicator comes on if the trunk This indicator reminds you that the
turn the ignition switch to the ON lid is not closed tightly. exterior lights are on. It comes on
(II) position and release the parking when the light switch is in either the
brake, it means there is a problem Door-open Indicator or position. If you turn the

Instruments and Controls


with the DRL. There may also be a ignition switch to the ACCESSORY
problem with the high beam This indicator comes on if either (I) or LOCK (0) position without
headlights. Have your vehicle door is not closed tightly. turning off the light switch, this
checked by your dealer. indicator will stay on. A reminder
Washer Level Indicator chime will also sound when you open
High Beam Indicator the driver’s door.
Canadian models only
This indicator comes on with the This indicator comes on when the
high beam headlights. For more washer fluid level is low. Add washer
information, see page 72 . fluid when you see this indicator
(see page 241 ).
This indicator also comes on with
reduced brightness when the
daytime running lights (DRL) are on
(see page 73 ).

63
07/10/30 14:13:04 31SVA620 0069 

Instrument Panel Indicators

Security System Indicator Low Fuel Indicator


Except Si Si
LOW FUEL INDICATOR

SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR

If equipped This indicator is located in the fuel


This indicator comes on when the gauge. It comes on as a reminder
security system is set. See page that you must refuel soon.
181 for more information on the
security system. When the indicator comes on, there
are about 1.9 US gal (7.5 ) of fuel
remaining in the tank.
When the reading reaches E, there is
a very small amount of fuel in the
tank.

64
07/07/11 15:16:16 31SVA620 0070 

Gauges

SEL/RESET BUTTON
SPEEDOMETER
TEMPERATURE GAUGE

Instruments and Controls


FUEL
GAUGE

TACHOMETER

To switch the information display


between the odometer, trip meter,
and outside temperature (if
equipped), and engine oil life and
INFORMATION
maintenance service items, press the
DISPLAY SEL/RESET button repeatedly.

ODOMETER/OUTSIDE TRIP METER


TEMPERATURE INDICATOR*

U.S. model with A/T is shown.

*: If equipped

65
07/07/11 15:16:24 31SVA620 0071 

Gauges

Display Change Button Odometer Trip Meter


This shows the total distance your This meter shows the number of
DISPLAY CHANGE BUTTON vehicle has been driven. It measures miles or kilometers driven since you
miles or kilometers. last reset it.
It is illegal under U.S. federal law and
Canadian provincial regulations to There are two trip meters: Trip A
disconnect, reset, or alter the and Trip B. Switch between these
odometer with the intent to change displays by pressing the SEL/
the number of miles or kilometers RESET button repeatedly. Each trip
indicated. meter works independently, so you
can keep track of two different
The odometer and the outside distances.
temperature indicator (if equipped)
use the same display. To switch the When you turn the ignition switch to
Press and hold the display change display between them, press the the ON (II) position, what you last
button until you hear a beep. The SEL/RESET button repeatedly. selected is displayed.
speedometer, trip meter, and When you turn the ignition switch to
odometer readings switch between the ON (II) position, your last To reset a trip meter, display it, and
miles per hour (mph) and kilometers selection is displayed. then press and hold the SEL/RESET
per hour (km/h). button until the number resets to
‘‘0.0.’’

66
07/07/11 15:16:32 31SVA620 0072 

Gauges

Outside Temperature Indicator If the outside temperature is In certain weather conditions,


If equipped incorrectly displayed, you can adjust temperature readings near freezing
This indicator displays the outside it up to ±5°F in U.S. models (±3°C (32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice is
temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S. in Canadian models) warmer or forming on the road surface.
models) or Centigrade (Canadian cooler.
models). To see the outside

Instruments and Controls


temperature, press and release the NOTE: The temperature must be
SEL/RESET button until the stabilized before doing this
temperature is shown on the procedure.
information display.
Select the outside temperature
The temperature sensor is in the display, then press and hold the
front bumper. Therefore, the SEL/RESET button for 10 seconds.
temperature reading can be affected The following sequence will appear
by heat reflection from the road for 1 second each: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, −5,
surface, engine heat, and the −4, −3, −2, −1, 0 (U.S.) or 0, 1, 2,
exhaust from surrounding traffic. 3, −3, −2, −1, 0 (Canada).
This can cause an incorrect
temperature reading when your When it reaches the desired value,
speed is under 19 mph (30 km/h). release the SEL/RESET button. You
should see the new outside
The sensor delays the display update temperature displayed.
until it reaches the correct outside
temperature. This may take several
minutes.

67
07/07/11 15:16:38 31SVA620 0073 

Gauges

Fuel Gauge Temperature Gauge Check Fuel Cap Message


This shows how much fuel you have. This shows the temperature of the Your vehicle’s onboard diagnostic
It may show slightly more or less engine’s coolant. During normal system will detect a loose or missing
than the actual amount. operation, the reading should rise to fuel fill cap as an evaporative system
about the middle of the gauge. In leak. The first time a leak is detected
severe driving conditions, such as a ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’ message
very hot weather or a long period of appears on the information display.
Avoid driving with an extremely low uphill driving, the reading may rise Turn the engine off, and confirm the
f uel level. Running out of f uel could into the upper half of the gauge. If it fuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosen
cause the engine to misf ire, damaging reaches the red (Hot) mark, pull it, then retighten it until it clicks at
the catalytic converter. safely to the side of the road. See least once. The message should go
page 279 for instructions and off after several days of normal
precautions on checking the engine driving once you tighten or replace
cooling system. the fuel fill cap. To scroll to another
display, press the SEL/RESET
button. The ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’
message will appear each time you
restart the engine until the system
turns the message off.

68
07/07/11 15:16:43 31SVA620 0074 

Gauges

If the system still detects a leak in Maintenance Minder


your vehicle’s evaporative emissions The information display in the
system, the malfunction indicator instrument panel shows you the
lamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fill engine oil life and maintenance
cap was not already tightened, turn service items when the ignition
the engine off, and check or switch is in the ON (II) position. This

Instruments and Controls


retighten the fuel fill cap until it information helps to keep you aware
clicks at least once. The MIL should of the periodic maintenance your
go off after several days of normal vehicle needs for continued trouble-
driving once the cap is tightened or free driving. Refer to page 225 for
replaced. If the MIL does not go off, more information.
have your vehicle inspected by a
dealer. For more information, see
page 282 .

69
07/07/11 15:16:51 31SVA620 0075 

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

HEADLIGHTS/ TURN SIGNALS WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS PASSENGER’S AIRBAG OFF


(P.72) (P.71) INDICATOR (P.29)
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRIGHTNESS
(P.73)

AUDIO SYSTEM*2
MIRROR CONTROLS*2
(P.104) (P.119)

VEHICLE STABILITY REAR WINDOW


ASSIST (VSA) SYSTEM DEFOGGER
OFF SWITCH* (P.74)
(P.217) HEATED MIRRORS*2
HORN*1 (P.105)
HAZARD WARNING
REMOTE BUTTON (P.74)
AUDIO
NAVIGATION SYSTEM CONTROLS *2
ACCESSORY POWER
VOICE CONTROL CRUISE CONTROL SOCKET (P.108)
(P.177) BUTTONS*2
BUTTONS*3
STEERING WHEEL (P.182) AUXILIARY INPUT JACK*2
ADJUSTMENTS (P.178)
Vehicle without navigation system is shown. (P.75)

*1: To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
*2: If equipped.
*3: Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.
70
07/07/11 15:17:00 31SVA620 0076 

Windshield Wipers and Washers

MIST − The wipers run at high Windshield Washers − Pull the


speed until you release the lever. wiper control lever toward you, and
hold it. The washers spray until you
OFF − The wipers are not activated. release the lever. The wipers run at
low speed, then complete one more
INT − The wipers operate every sweep after you release the lever.

Instruments and Controls


few seconds.

On EX, EX-L and Si models in the U.S.,


* and LX, EX, EX-L and Si models in
ADJUSTMENT RING
Canada
*: EX, EX-L, Si, Canadian LX The length of the wiper interval is
varied automatically according to the
1. MIST vehicle’s speed.
2. OFF
3. INT − Intermittent Vary the delay by turning the
4. LO − Low speed adjustment ring. If you turn it to the
5. HI − High speed shortest delay ( position), the
6. Windshield washers wipers change to low speed
operation when the vehicle speed
Push the right lever up or down to exceeds 12 mph (20km/h).
select a position.
LO − The wipers run at low speed.

HI − The wipers run at high speed.

71
07/07/11 15:17:09 31SVA620 0077 

Turn Signals and Headlights

Turn Signal − Push down on the When the light switch is in the
lever to signal a left turn and up to ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position, the
signal a right turn. To signal a lane lights on indicator comes on as a
change, push lightly on the lever, reminder.
and hold it. The lever will return to
center when you release it or This indicator stays on if you leave
complete a turn. the lights on and turn the ignition
switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or
Headlights On − Turning the LOCK (0) position.
switch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turns
on the parking lights, taillights, High Beams − Push the lever
instrument panel lights, side-marker forward until you hear a click. The
lights, and rear license plate lights. high beam indicator will come on
1. Turn signal (see page 63 ). Pull the lever back to
2. Off Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’ return to the low beams.
3. Parking and indicator lights position turns on the headlights.
4. Headlights on To flash the high beams, pull the
5. High beams If you leave the lights on with the lever back lightly, then release it.
6. Flash high beams key removed from the ignition The high beams will stay on as long
switch, you will hear a reminder as you hold the lever back.
chime when you open the driver’s
door.

72
07/07/11 15:17:17 31SVA620 0078 

Headlights, Instrument Panel Brightness

Daytime Running Lights Instrument Panel Brightness when you reach the maximum or
With the headlight switch off or in minimum brightness. The display
the position, the high beam CONTROL BUTTONS returns to the odometer 5 seconds
headlights and the high beam after you stop adjusting the
indicator come on with reduced brightness.
brightness when you turn the

Instruments and Controls


ignition switch to the ON (II) To reduce glare at night, the
position and release the parking instrument panel illumination dims
brake. They remain on until you turn when you turn the light switch to the
the ignition switch off, even if you or position.
set the parking brake.
The center of each meter (upper and
The headlights revert to normal lower) illuminates with reduced
operation when you turn them on brightness when you unlock and
with the switch. The buttons under the left side vent open the driver’s door, and then goes
control the brightness of the back to the selected brightness when
instrument panel. Push the + or − you turn the ignition switch to the
button to adjust the brightness. ON (II) position.

Separate adjustments can be made If you insert the key but do not turn
when the headlights are on and off. the ignition switch to the ON (II)
position, the illumination turns off in
There are six brightness levels. about 10 seconds.
When you push either button, the
information display indicates the
current level. You will hear a tone

73
07/07/11 15:17:25 31SVA620 0079 

Hazard Warning Button, Rear Window Defogger

Hazard Warning Button Rear Window Defogger Make sure the rear window is clear
and you have good visibility before
starting to drive.

The defogger and antenna wires on


the inside of the rear window can be
accidentally damaged. When
cleaning the glass, always wipe side-
to-side.

On U.S. EX-L, Canadian LX, EX, EX-L


and Si models
U.S. EX-L, Canadian LX, EX, EX-L, Si Pushing this button also turns the
mirror heaters on or off. For more
Push the button to turn on the The rear window defogger will clear information, see page 105 .
hazard warning lights (four-way fog, frost, and thin ice from the
flashers). This causes all four window. Push the defogger button to
outside turn signals and both turn turn it on and off. The indicator in
indicators in the instrument panel to the button comes on to show the
flash. Use the hazard warning lights defogger is on. If you do not turn it
if you need to park in a dangerous off, the defogger will shut itself off
area near heavy traffic, or if your after about 15 minutes. It also shuts
vehicle is disabled. off when you turn off the ignition
switch. You have to turn the
defogger on again when you restart
the vehicle.

74
07/07/11 15:17:31 31SVA620 0080 

Steering Wheel Adjustments

Make any steering wheel 3. Push the lever up to lock the


adjustments before you start driving. steering wheel in position.

4. Make sure you have securely


locked the steering wheel in place
Adjusting the steering wheel by trying to move it up, down, in,

Instruments and Controls


position while driving may and out.
cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured
in a crash.

Adjust the steering wheel only


when the vehicle is stopped.
1. Push the lever under the steering
column all the way down.

2. Move the steering wheel up or


down, and in or out, so it points
toward your chest, not toward
your face. Make sure you can see
the instrument panel gauges and
indicators.

75
07/07/11 15:17:39 31SVA620 0081 

Keys and Locks

All EX, EX-L and Si models, and Canadian U.S. LX and Canadian DX-G models The master key fits all the locks on
LX model your vehicle. The valet key works
MASTER KEY WITH MASTER KEY WITH
only in the ignition and the driver’s
REMOTE TRANSMITTER REMOTE TRANSMITTER door lock*. You can keep the trunk
VALET KEY KEY NUMBER VALET KEY
and trunk release handle locked
KEY NUMBER
TAG (Gray) TAG (Gray) when you leave your vehicle and the
valet key at a parking facility.

*On DX model (except Canadian


DX-G), the passenger’s door can
also be locked or unlocked with
the key.

You should have received a key


DX model (except Canadian DX-G) number tag with your keys. You will
MASTER KEYS (Black) need this key number if you ever
KEY NUMBER VALET KEY have to get a lost key replaced. Use
TAG (Gray) only Honda-approved key blanks.

76
07/07/11 15:17:49 31SVA620 0082 

Keys and Locks, Immobilizer System

These keys contain electronic Immobilizer System If the system repeatedly does not
circuits that are activated by the The immobilizer system protects recognize the coding of your key,
immobilizer system. They will not your vehicle from theft. If an contact your dealer.
work to start the engine if the improperly-coded key (or other
circuits are damaged. device) is used, the engine’s fuel Do not attempt to alter this system
system is disabled. or add other devices to it. Electrical

Instruments and Controls


Protect the keys from direct problems could result that may make
sunlight, high temperature, and When you turn the ignition switch to your vehicle undrivable.
high humidity. the ON (II) position, the immobilizer
system indicator should come on If you have lost your key and cannot
Do not drop the keys or set heavy briefly, then go off. If the indicator start your engine, contact your
objects on them. starts to blink, it means the system dealer.
does not recognize the coding of the
Keep the keys away from liquids. key. Turn the ignition switch to the
If they get wet, dry them LOCK (0) position, remove the key,
immediately with a soft cloth. reinsert it, and turn the ignition Always take the ignition key with you
switch to the ON (II) position again. whenever you leave the vehicle alone.
The valet key does not contain a
battery. Do not try to take it apart. The system may not recognize your
key’s coding if another immobilizer
On DX model (except Canadian DX-G) key or other metal object (i.e. key
The keys do not contain batteries. fob) is near the ignition switch when
Do not try to take them apart. you insert the key.

CONTINUED

77
07/07/11 15:17:57 31SVA620 0083 

Immobilizer System, Ignition Switch

As required by the FCC: Ignition Switch If the front wheels are turned, the
This device complies with Part 15 of the anti-theft lock may make it difficult
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the to turn the key. Firmly turn the
following two conditions: (1) This device steering wheel to the left or right as
may not cause harmful interference, and you turn the key.
(2) this device must accept any
interference received, including ACCESSORY (I) − You can
interference that may cause undesired operate the audio system and the
operation. accessory power sockets in this
position.
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for ON (II) − This is the normal key
compliance could void the user’s position when driving. Several of the
authority to operate the equipment. indicators on the instrument panel
The ignition switch has four come on as a test when you turn the
This device complies with Industry positions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY ignition switch from the
Canada Standard RSS-210. (I), ON (II), and START (III). ACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II)
Operation is subject to the following two position.
conditions: (1) this device may not cause LOCK (0) − You can insert or
interference, and (2) this device must remove the key only in this position. START (III) − Use this position
accept any interference that may cause To turn the key, push it in slightly. If only to start the engine. The switch
undesired operation of the device. your vehicle has an automatic returns to the ON (II) position when
transmission, the shift lever must you let go of the key.
also be in park.

78
07/07/11 15:18:05 31SVA620 0084 

Ignition Switch, Door Locks

You will hear a reminder beeper if Door Locks On DX model except Canadian DX-G
you leave the key in the ignition To lock the passenger’s door when
switch in the LOCK (0) or the LOCK LOCK TAB getting out of the vehicle, pull out
ACCESSORY (I) position and open the lock tab and close the door. To
the driver’s door. Remove the key to lock the driver’s door, pull and hold
turn off the beeper. the outside door handle then pull out

Instruments and Controls


the lock tab. Release the handle,
If your vehicle has an automatic then close the door.
transmission, the shift lever must be
in Park before you can remove the Each door can be locked or unlocked
key from the ignition switch. with the ignition key.

UNLOCK RED MARK

Removing the key from the Each door has a lock tab next to the
ignition switch while driving inside door handle. Pull out the tab
locks the steering. This can to lock the door, and push it in to
cause you to lose control of the unlock.
vehicle.
When the door is unlocked, the red
Remove the key from the mark on the lock tab is shown.
ignition switch only when
parked.

79
07/07/11 15:18:12 31SVA620 0085 

Door Locks

Power Door Locks The lock tab on the passenger’s door Lockout Prevention
locks and unlocks only that door. If you forget and leave the key in the
Pushing in the driver’s door lock tab ignition switch, lockout prevention
only unlocks the driver’s door. will not allow you to lock the driver’s
To unlock only the driver’s door door. With either door open and the
from the outside, turn the key and key in the ignition switch, locking
release it. If you turn it again, both with master door lock switch is
doors unlock. disabled. If the driver’s door is
closed, the lock tab on the driver’s
To lock the passenger’s door when door is not disabled. Pulling the
getting out of the vehicle, pull out driver’s lock tab rearward will lock
the lock tab and close the door. To both doors. If you try to lock an open
MASTER DOOR LOCK SWITCH lock the driver’s door, remove the driver’s door by pulling the lock tab
key from the ignition switch and pull rearward, the driver’s door lock tab
On LX, EX, EX-L and Si models in the out the lock tab or push the top of pops out and unlocks the driver’s
U.S., and DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L and Si the master switch, then close the door.
models in Canada door.
To lock the doors, push the top of
the master door lock switch on
either door, pull out the lock tab on
the driver’s door, or use the key in
the outside lock on the driver’s door.

Pushing the bottom of either master


door lock switch unlocks both doors.

80
07/08/02 16:19:00 31SVA620 0086 

Door Locks

Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Auto Door Locking To turn off the Auto Door Lock
On LX, EX, EX-L and Si models in the The auto door locking feature has modes:
U.S., and DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L and Si three possible settings:
models in Canada
Your vehicle has customizable The auto door locking is
settings for the doors to deactivated all the time.

Instruments and Controls


automatically lock and unlock. There
are default settings for each of these The doors lock whenever you
features. You can turn off or change move the shift lever out of the
the settings for these features as Park (P) position (A/T vehicles).
described on the following pages.
The doors lock when the vehicle
When you customize the setting, speed reaches 9 mph (15 km/h).
make sure your vehicle is parked This is the default setting.
safely, the engine is off, and apply
the parking brake. Make all settings 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the
before you start driving. Park (P) position (A/T vehicles).

2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON


(II) position, and open the driver’s
door.

CONTINUED

81
07/07/11 15:18:30 31SVA620 0087 

Door Locks

3. Push and hold the front of the To program the Park Lock mode: 3. Push and hold the front of the
master door lock switch on the Locks both doors when the shift lever is master door lock switch on the
driver’s door until you hear a click moved out of the Park (P) position (A/T driver’s door. You will hear a click.
(after about 5 seconds). vehicles only). Keep holding the switch until you
hear another click (after about 5
4. Release the switch, and within 5 seconds).
seconds, turn the ignition switch
to the LOCK (0) position. 4. Release the switch, and within 5
seconds, turn the ignition switch
to the LOCK (0) position.

1. Make sure the shift lever is in the


Park (P) position.

2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON


(II) position, and make sure to
close the driver’s door.

82
07/07/11 15:18:44 31SVA620 0088 

Door Locks

To program the Drive Lock mode: 4. Push and hold the front of the Auto Door Unlocking
Locks both doors when the vehicle’s master door lock switch on the The auto door unlocking feature has
speed reaches about 9 mph (15 km/h). driver’s door. You will hear a click. five possible settings:
Keep holding the switch until you The auto door unlocking is
hear another click (after about 5 deactivated all the time.
seconds).

Instruments and Controls


On A/T vehicles, the driver’s door
5. Release the switch, and within 5 unlocks when you move the shift
seconds, turn the ignition switch lever to the Park (P) position.
to the ACCESSORY (I) position. This is the default setting.
On A/T vehicles, move the shift
lever to the Park (P) position. Both doors unlock when you move
the shift lever to the Park (P)
6. Turn the ignition switch to the position (A/T vehicles).
LOCK (0) position.
The driver’s door unlocks
1. Make sure the shift lever is in the whenever you turn the ignition
Park (P) position (A/T vehicles). switch to the ACCESSORY (I)
position.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON This is the default setting on M/T
(II) position, and make sure to vehicles.
close the driver’s door.
Both doors unlock whenever you
3. On A/T vehicles, push and hold the turn the ignition switch to the
brake pedal, and move the shift ACCESSORY (I) position.
lever out of the Park (P) position. CONTINUED

83
07/07/11 15:18:53 31SVA620 0089 

Door Locks

To turn off the Auto Door Unlock 3. Push and hold the rear of the To program the Park Unlock mode:
modes: master door lock switch on the Unlocks the driver’s door or both doors
driver’s door. You will hear a click, when the shift lever is moved into the
and after about 5 seconds, you will Park (P) position (A/T vehicles only).
hear another click.

4. Release the switch, and within 5


seconds, turn the ignition switch
to the LOCK (0) position.

1. Make sure the shift lever is in the


Park (P) position (A/T vehicles).
1. Make sure the shift lever is in the
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON Park (P) position.
(II) position, and open the driver’s
door. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position, and make sure to
close the driver’s door.

84
07/07/11 15:19:03 31SVA620 0090 

Door Locks

3. Push and hold the rear of the To program the Ignition Switch 3. On A/T vehicles, push and hold the
master door lock switch on the Unlock mode: brake pedal, then move the shift
driver’s door. You will hear a click. Unlocks the driver’s door or both doors lever out of the Park (P) position.
Continue to hold the switch: when the ignition switch is moved out of
the ON (II) position. 4. Push and hold the rear of the
Until you hear another click master door lock switch on the

Instruments and Controls


(after about 5 seconds) to driver’s door. You will hear a click.
activate driver’s door unlock Continue to hold the switch:
feature,
Until you hear another click
Or, until you hear two more (after about 5 seconds) to
clicks (after about 10 seconds) activate driver’s door unlock
to activate both doors unlock feature.
feature.
Or, until you hear two more
4. Release the switch, and within 5 clicks (after about 10 seconds)
seconds, turn the ignition switch to activate both doors unlock
to the LOCK (0) position. feature.
1. Make sure the shift lever is in the
Park (P) position (A/T vehicles).

2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON


(II) position, and make sure to
close the driver’s door.

CONTINUED

85
07/07/11 15:19:12 31SVA620 0091 

Door Locks, Remote Transmitter

5. Release the switch, and within 5 Remote Transmitter


seconds, turn the ignition switch
to the ACCESSORY (I) position. U.S.: LX U.S.: EX, EX-L, Si
Canada: DX-G Canada: LX, EX, EX-L, Si
On A/T vehicles, move the shift
lever to the Park (P) position. LED LED
LOCK LOCK
BUTTON BUTTON
6. Turn the ignition switch to the UNLOCK UNLOCK
LOCK (0) position. BUTTON BUTTON

Even though your vehicle’s battery is


removed or goes dead, the system TRUNK
keeps the auto door lock/unlock PANIC PANIC RELEASE
setting which you selected. BUTTON BUTTON BUTTON

U.S.: LX, EX, EX-L, Si UNLOCK − Press this button once


Canada: DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L, Si to unlock the driver’s door. Push it
LOCK − Press this button once to twice to unlock the passenger’s door.
lock both doors. Some exterior lights Some exterior lights will flash twice
will flash once. When you push each time you push the button.
LOCK twice within 5 seconds, you
will hear a beep to verify that the
doors are locked and that the
security system (if equipped) has set.
You cannot lock the doors if either
door is not fully closed or the key is
in the ignition switch.

86
07/07/11 15:19:20 31SVA620 0092 

Remote Transmitter

The ceiling light and the door EX, EX-L, Si and Canadian LX models Remote Transmitter Care
activated spotlights (if equipped) TRUNK RELEASE − Press this Avoid dropping or throwing the
come on when you press the button for about 1 second to open transmitter.
UNLOCK button if the lights are in the trunk. You cannot open the trunk
the door activated position. If you do if the key is in the ignition switch. Protect the transmitter from
not open either door within 30 extreme temperature.

Instruments and Controls


seconds, the light(s) will fade out. If PANIC − Press and hold this
you relock the doors with the remote button for about 2 seconds to attract Do not immerse the transmitter in
transmitter before 30 seconds have attention: the horn will sound and any liquid.
elapsed, the light(s) will go off the exterior lights will flash for about
immediately. 30 seconds. To cancel panic mode, If you lose a transmitter, the
press any other button on the remote replacement needs to be
If you do not open either door within transmitter, or turn the ignition reprogrammed by your dealer.
30 seconds, the doors automatically switch to the ON (II) position.
relock, and the security system (if
equipped) sets. You cannot unlock it
if the key is in the ignition switch.

CONTINUED

87
07/07/11 15:19:28 31SVA620 0093 

Remote Transmitter

Replacing the Transmitter


Battery
If it takes several pushes on the
button to lock or unlock the doors,
replace the battery as soon as
BATTERY
possible.

Battery type: CR1616

To replace the battery: SCREW


1. Remove the screw at the base of TAB
the transmitter with a small Model with trunk release is shown.
Phillips-head screwdriver.
2. Separate the transmitter by prying 3. Inside the transmitter, separate
NOTE: Be careful when removing its middle seam with your the inner cover from the keypad
this screw as the head of the screw fingernail. by releasing the two tabs on the
can strip out. cover.

88
07/07/12 17:24:12 31SVA620 0094 

Remote Transmitter

4. Remove the old battery from the As required by the FCC:


back of the inner cover, and insert This device complies with Part 15 of the
a new battery into the back of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
cover with the + side facing down. following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
An improperly disposed of battery (2) this device must accept any

Instruments and Controls


can be harmful to the environment interference received, including
and human health. interference that may cause undesired
Always confirm local regulations operation.
for battery disposal.
Changes or modifications not expressly
5. Install the parts in reverse order. approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with Industry


Canada Standard RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device.

89
07/07/11 19:57:05 31SVA620 0095 

Trunk

U.S. DX and LX, Canadian DX and DX-G


Keep the trunk lid closed at all times
while driving to avoid damaging the
Pull lid, and to prevent exhaust gas from
getting into the interior. See Carbon
Monoxide Hazard on page 50 .

TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE MASTER KEY

You can open the trunk in two ways: On U.S. DX and LX models, and
Canadian DX and DX-G models
Pull the trunk release handle to Use the master key to open the
the left of the driver’s seat. trunk lock. The valet key does not
work in this lock.
On EX, EX-L, Si and
Canadian LX models To close the trunk, press down on
Press and hold the trunk release the trunk lid.
button on the remote transmitter.

90
07/07/11 15:19:50 31SVA620 0096 

Trunk

On EX, EX-L, Si and Canadian LX Emergency Trunk Opener


Even if the trunk release lever is
locked with the master key, you can
open the trunk with the remote
transmitter.

Instruments and Controls


MASTER KEY

To protect items in the trunk when


you need to give the key to someone As a safety feature, your vehicle has
else: a release lever on the trunk latch so
the trunk can be opened from the
1. Lock the trunk release handle inside. To open the trunk, push the
with the master key. release lever to the left.

2. Give the person the valet key. Parents should decide if their
children should be shown how to use
this feature. For more information
about child safety, see page 35 .

91
07/07/11 15:19:57 31SVA620 0097 

Seats

Front Seat Adjustments


See pages 11 − 13 for important safety
information and warnings about how to
properly position the seats and seat-
backs.

Make all seat adjustments before


you start driving.

To adjust the seat forward or To change the seat-back angle, pull


backward, pull up on the bar under up on the lever on the outside of the
the seat cushion’s front edge. Move seat bottom.
the seat to the desired position, and
release the bar. Try to move the seat Once a seat is adjusted correctly,
to make sure it is locked in position. rock it back and forth to make sure it
is locked in position.

92
07/07/11 15:20:06 31SVA620 0098 

Seats

Driver’s Seat Height Adjustment Armrest Rear Seat Access

Instruments and Controls


SEAT-BACK ADJUSTMENT LEVER

The height of your driver’s seat is On all models except DX Driver’s Side
adjustable. To raise the seat bottom, To use the console lid as an armrest, To get into the rear seat on the
repeatedly pull up the lever on the slide it to one of its three positions. driver’s side, open the door and pull
outside of the seat cushion. To lower up on the seat-back adjustment lever.
the seat, push the lever down The seat-back will tilt forward to
repeatedly. allow easier entry to the rear seat.

Make all seat adjustments before


you start driving.

CONTINUED

93
07/07/11 15:20:11 31SVA620 0099 

Seats

Passenger’s Side Except U.S. DX


When you push down the release
RELEASE LEVER
lever or pull up the adjustment lever,
the seat will also move forward.
After a passenger gets into the back
seat, push the seat-back to the
upright position, and push the seat
backwards until it latches. Make
sure the seat is fully latched before
sitting in it.

To get into the rear seat on the


passenger’s side, push downward on
the release lever at the base of the
seat-back or pull up on the seat-back
adjustment lever. The seat-back will
tilt forward to allow easier entry to
the rear seat.

94
07/07/11 15:20:19 31SVA620 0100 

Seats

Head Restraints FRONT


See page 13 for important safety
information and a warning about
improperly positioning head restraints.

Your vehicle is equipped with head

Instruments and Controls


restraints in all seating positions to
help protect you and your
passengers from whiplash and other
injuries. RELEASE
BUTTON
LEGS SEAT-BACK

They are most effective when you Adjusting the Head Restraint
adjust them so the center of the back The head restraints adjust for height.
of the occupant’s head rests against You need both hands to adjust a
the center of the restraint. restraint. Do not attempt to adjust it
while driving. To raise it, pull upward.
To lower the restraint, push the
release button sideways, and push
the restraint down.

CONTINUED

95
07/07/11 15:20:26 31SVA620 0101 

Seats

Rear Center Position Removing the Head Restraint


To remove a head restraint for
LEG cleaning or repair, pull it up as far as Failure to reinstall the head
it will go. Push the release button, restraints can result in severe
then pull the restraint out of the seat- injury during a crash.
back.
Always replace the head
restraints before driving.

When reinstalling a head restraint,


SEAT-BACK RELEASE BUTTON put the legs back in place. Then
adjust it to the appropriate height
When a passenger is seated in the while pressing the release button.
rear center seating position, the
center head restraint should be Make sure the head restraint locks
adjusted up or down, to match the in position when you reinstall it.
passenger’s height.

96
07/07/11 15:20:35 31SVA620 0102 

Seats

Active Head Restraints against whiplash and injuries to the For a head restraint system to work
neck and upper spine. properly:

After a collision, the activated Do not hang any items on the head
restraint should return to its normal restraints, or from the restraint
position. legs.

Instruments and Controls


If the restraints do not return to their Do not place any object between
normal position, or in the event of a an occupant and the seat-back.
severe collision, have the vehicle
inspected by a Honda dealer. Install each restraint in its proper
location.

Only use genuine Honda


The driver’s and front passenger’s replacement head restraints.
seats have active head restraints. If
the vehicle is struck severely from
the rear, the occupant properly
secured with the seat belt will be
pushed against the seat-back and the
head restraint will automatically
move forward.

This reduces the distance between


the restraint and the occupant’s head.
It also helps protect the occupants

97
07/07/11 15:20:43 31SVA620 0103 

Seats

Folding Rear Seat

GUIDE RELEASE

The back of the rear seat folds down When storing cargo, you can move To release the seat-back, pull the
to give you direct access to the trunk. the rear center shoulder belt out of release under the trunk panel. Push
The seat-back can be released from the way by removing the belt from the seat-back down, then let go of
inside the trunk. the guide. the release.
For 60/40 split rear fold-down seat
On all models except DX and U.S. LX Remove any items from the seat models, a release is located on each
The left and right halves can be before you fold down the seat-back. side of the trunk.
folded separately.
For full rear fold-down seat models,
the release is located on the driver’s
side of the trunk.

98
07/07/11 15:20:50 31SVA620 0104 

Seats

Make sure that the folded seat-back Make sure all rear shoulder belts are
does not press against the front positioned in front of the rear seat-
passenger’s seat, as this could cause back, and the center shoulder belt is
the weight sensors to work re-positioned in the guide whenever
improperly. the seat-back is in its upright position.
Be sure there are no twists in any

Instruments and Controls


If the rear head restraints get caught shoulder belt.
on the front seat backs and you
cannot fold down the rear seat-back Do not put any heavy items on the
fully, you can remove the head seat-back when it is folded down.
restraints (see page 96 ).
Make sure the removed head Make sure all items in the trunk, or
restraints are securely stored. items extending through the opening
into the back seat, are secured.
To lock the seat-back upright, push it Loose items can fly forward and
firmly against the trunk panel. Make cause injury if you have to brake
sure it is latched in place by pulling hard. See Carrying Cargo on page
on the top of the seat. 197 .

Never drive with the seat-back


folded down and the trunk lid open.
See Carbon Monoxide Hazard on
page 50 .

99
07/07/11 15:20:58 31SVA620 0105 

Power Windows

DRIVER’S WINDOW SWITCH AUTO − To open the driver’s


window fully, push the window
Closing a power window on switch firmly down, then release it.
someone’s hands or fingers can The window automatically goes
cause serious injury. down all the way. To stop the
window from going all the way down,
Make sure your passengers are pull back on the window switch
away from the windows before briefly.
closing them.
To close the driver’s window fully,
pull back the window switch firmly,
MAIN SWITCH The driver’s armrest has a master then release it. The window
power window control panel. To automatically goes all the way up. To
If equipped open the passenger’s window, push stop the window from going all the
Turn the ignition switch to the ON down on the switch and hold it down way up, push down on the window
(II) position to raise or lower either until the window reaches the desired switch briefly.
window. To open a window, push the position. To close the window, pull
switch down and hold it. Release the back on the window switch. Release To open or close the driver’s window
switch when you want the window to the switch when the window gets to partially, push down or pull back on
stop. Pull back on the switch and the position you want. the window switch lightly and hold it.
hold it to close the window. The window will stop when you
release the switch.
The windows operate for up to 10
minutes after you turn off the
ignition switch. Opening either door
cancels this function.

100
07/07/11 15:21:04 31SVA620 0106 

Power Windows

When you push the MAIN switch in, AUTO REVERSE − If the driver’s If your vehicle’s battery is
the switch is OFF, and the window runs into any obstacle while disconnected or goes dead, or the
passenger’s window cannot be raised it is closing automatically, it will driver’s window fuse is removed, the
or lowered. To cancel this feature, reverse direction, and then stop. To AUTO function could be disabled. If
push on the switch again to get it to close the window, remove the the power window system needs to
pop out. Keep the MAIN switch off obstacle, then use the window switch be reset after reconnecting the

Instruments and Controls


when you have children in the again. battery or installing the fuse, do this:
vehicle so they do not injure
themselves by operating the window Auto reverse stops sensing when the 1. Start the engine. Push down and
unintentionally. window is almost closed. You should hold the driver’s window switch
always check that all passengers and until the window is fully open.
objects are away from the window
before closing it. 2. Pull and hold the driver’s window
switch to close the window
NOTE: Only on the driver’s window, completely, then hold the switch
the auto reverse function is disabled for about 2 seconds.
when you continuously pull up the
switch. If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, have your
vehicle checked by your dealer.

101
07/07/11 15:21:12 31SVA620 0107 

Moonroof

To tilt up the moonroof, push on the AUTO − To open the moonroof


MOONROOF SWITCH center of the moonroof switch. To fully, pull back the moonroof switch
stop the moonroof from tilting up firmly, then release it. The moonroof
Open fully, push the switch briefly. automatically opens all the way. To
stop the moonroof from opening,
To open the moonroof, pull back on push the switch briefly.
the switch and hold it. Release the
switch when the moonroof reaches To close the moonroof fully, firmly
the desired position. To close the push the moonroof switch forward,
moonroof, push the switch forward then release it. The moonroof
Tilt and hold it. Release the switch to automatically closes all the way. To
Close
stop the operation. stop the moonroof from closing,
push the switch briefly.
If equipped
The moonroof can be tilted up in the To open or close the moonroof
back for ventilation, or it can be slid Opening or closing the partially, lightly pull the switch back
back into the roof. Use the switch on moonroof on someone’s hands or push it forward and hold it. The
the front ceiling to operate the or fingers can cause serious moonroof will stop when you release
moonroof. You must turn the injury. the switch.
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position to operate the moonroof. Make sure all hands and fingers
are clear of the moonroof
before opening or closing it.

102
07/07/11 15:21:17 31SVA620 0108 

Moonroof

AUTO REVERSE − If the The moonroof has a key-off delay.


moonroof runs into any obstacle You can open and close the
while it is closing automatically, it moonroof for up to 10 minutes after
will reverse direction and then stop. you turn off the ignition switch. The
To close the moonroof, remove the key-off delay cancels as soon as you
obstacle, then use the moonroof open either door.

Instruments and Controls


switch again.

Auto reverse stops sensing when the


moonroof is almost closed. You If you try to open the moonroof in
should always check that all below-f reezing temperatures, or when
passengers and objects are away it is covered with snow or ice, you can
from the moonroof before closing it. damage the moonroof panel or motor.

103
07/07/11 15:21:26 31SVA620 0109 

Mirrors

Adjusting the Power Mirrors 3. Push the appropriate edge of the


adjustment switch to move the
TAB SELECTOR SWITCH mirror right, left, up, or down.

4. When you finish, move the


selector switch to the center (off)
position. This turns the
adjustment switch off to keep your
settings.

ADJUSTMENT SWITCH
Keep the inside and outside mirrors
clean and adjusted for best visibility. If equipped
Be sure to adjust the mirrors before 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
you start driving. (II) position.

The inside mirror has day and night 2. Move the selector switch to L
positions. The night position reduces (driver’s side) or R (passenger’s
glare from headlights behind you. side).
Flip the tab on the bottom edge of
the mirror to select the day or night
position.

104
07/07/11 15:21:33 31SVA620 0110 

Mirrors, Parking Brake

Power Mirror Heaters Parking Brake

Driving the vehicle with the parking


brake applied can damage the rear
brakes and axles. A beeper will sound
if the vehicle is driven with the parking

Instruments and Controls


brake on.

REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/


HEATED MIRRORS BUTTON PARKING BRAKE LEVER

EX-L model in the U.S. To apply the parking brake, pull the
LX, EX, EX-L and Si models in Canada lever up fully. To release it, pull up
The outside mirrors are heated to slightly, push the button, and lower
remove fog and frost. With the the lever. The parking brake
ignition switch in the ON (II) indicator on the instrument panel
position, turn on the heaters by should go out when the parking
pressing the rear window defogger brake is fully released (see page 58 ).
button. The indicator in the button
comes on as a reminder. Press the
button again to turn the heaters and
the defogger off.

105
07/07/11 15:21:38 31SVA620 0111 

Interior Convenience Items

CONSOLE COMPARTMENT* VANITY MIRROR


SIDE POCKET
SUN VISOR
COAT HOOK
ACCESSORY
POWER SOCKET

BEVERAGE HOLDER
GLOVE BOX

CENTER POCKET

AUXILIARY INPUT JACK*

*:If equipped ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET* SEAT-BACK POCKET BEVERAGE HOLDER

106
07/07/11 15:21:47 31SVA620 0112 

Interior Convenience Items

Beverage Holders Console Compartment Glove Box


Be careful when you are using the
beverage holders. A spilled liquid
that is very hot can scald you or your
passengers. Spilled liquids can
damage the upholstery, carpeting,

Instruments and Controls


and electrical components in the
interior.
LEVER

CONSOLE COMPARTMENT

If equipped Open the glove box by pulling the


To open the console compartment, handle to the left. Close it with a firm
pull up on the lever, and lift the lid. push.

To close, lower the lid, and push it


down until it latches.

Open the front beverage holder by


sliding the lid.

CONTINUED

107
07/07/11 15:21:55 31SVA620 0113 

Interior Convenience Items

Coat Hook Accessory Power Sockets

An open glove box can cause FRONT


serious injury to your passenger
in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat
belt.

Always keep the glove box


closed while driving.

COAT HOOK

To use a coat hook, pull it down. To use an accessory power socket,


Close it with a firm push. pull up the cover.

Make sure the coat hook is closed This socket is intended to supply
when you are not using it. This hook power for 12 volt DC accessories
is not designed for large or heavy that are rated 120 watts or less (10
items. amps).
To use an accessory power socket,
the ignition switch must be in the
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.

108
07/07/11 15:22:02 31SVA620 0114 

Interior Convenience Items

Make sure to put the socket cover Vanity Mirror


back in place to prevent any small
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT foreign objects getting into the
socket.

Instruments and Controls


EX, EX-L and Si

On EX, EX-L and Si models To use the vanity mirror on the back
Another accessory power socket is in of the sun visor, pull up the cover.
the center console compartment.

None of the sockets will power an


automotive type cigarette lighter
element. When both sockets are
being used, the combined power
rating of the accessories should be
120 watts or less (10 amps).

109
07/07/11 15:22:06 31SVA620 0115 

Interior Convenience Items

Sun Visor Make sure you put the sun visor


back in place when you are getting
into or out of the vehicle.

SUN VISOR

To use the sun visor, pull it down.


When using the sun visor for the
side window, remove the support rod
from the clip, and swing it out.

110
07/07/11 15:22:15 31SVA620 0116 

Interior Lights

Ceiling Light After both doors are closed tightly, Spotlights


the light dims slightly, then fades out
DOOR ACTIVATED in about 30 seconds.

ON The ceiling light (with the switch in


the center position) comes on when

Instruments and Controls


you remove the key from the ignition
OFF switch. If you do not open a door, the
light stays on, then fades out in
about 30 seconds.

If you leave either door open without


the key in the ignition switch, the On models without moonroof
ceiling light goes off after 3 minutes.
The ceiling light has a three-position Turn on a spotlight by pushing the
switch; ON, Door Activated, and lens. Push the lens again to turn it
OFF. In the Door Activated (center) off. You can use the spotlights at all
position, the light comes on when times.
you:

Open either door.

Unlock the doors with the key or


the remote transmitter.

CONTINUED

111
07/07/11 15:22:20 31SVA620 0117 

Interior Lights

On models with moonroof Courtesy Light


The spotlights have a two-position On models with moonroof
switch. In the DOOR position, the The courtesy light between the
lights come on when you open either spotlights comes on when you turn
door. In the OFF position, the lights the parking lights on. To adjust its
do not come on. brightness, push the instrument
panel brightness control buttons
COURTESY LIGHT under the driver’s side vent with the
OFF POSITION
ignition switch in the ON (II)
position.

DOOR ACTIVATED SPOTLIGHT

The spotlights (with the switch in


the DOOR position) also come on
when you unlock the door with the
key or the remote transmitter, and
when you remove the key from the
ignition switch.

112
07/07/11 15:22:27 31SVA620 0118 

Features

The heating and air conditioning* Vents, Heating, and A/C .............. 114 Setting the Clock ........................... 180
systems in your vehicle provide a Audio System ................................. 119 Security System ............................. 181
comfortable driving environment in Audio System (Models without Cruise Control ................................ 182
all weather conditions. navigation system) ................ 120

Air conditioning is optional on DX Playing the AM/FM Radio....... 121
model. Playing the XM Satellite
Radio (Optional) .................... 125
The standard audio system has Playing a Disc ............................. 130

Features
many features. This section Disc Player Error Messages .... 136
describes those features and how to Optional Disc Changer Error
use them. (If you have an optional Messages ................................ 137
audio system, refer to the operating Audio System (Models with
instructions that came with it.) navigation system) ................ 138
Voice Control System................ 138
If equipped Playing the AM/FM Radio....... 138
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audio Playing the XM Satellite
system that requires a code number Radio ....................................... 142
to enable it. Playing a Disc ............................. 150
Disc Player Error Messages .... 158
U.S. LX, EX, EX-L and Si models Playing a PC Card ...................... 159
The security system helps to PC card Error Messages .......... 171
discourage vandalism and theft of AM/FM Radio Reception ............. 172
your vehicle. Protecting Your Discs ................... 174
Remote Audio Controls................. 177
Navigation systems are optional on Auxiliary Input Jack ....................... 178
U.S. EX, EX-L and Si models only. Radio Theft Protection.................. 179

113
07/07/11 15:22:32 31SVA620 0119 

Vents, Heating, and A/C

MODE BUTTONS

FAN CONTROL DIAL TEMPERATURE CONTROL


DIAL

MAX A/C BUTTON* REAR WINDOW



DEFOGGER BUTTON/
AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON HEATED MIRRORS*

RECIRCULATION BUTTON

* : If equipped

114
07/10/30 14:05:36 31SVA620 0120 

Vents, Heating, and A/C

Fan Control Dial Recirculation Button Rear Window Defogger


Turn this dial to increase or decrease When the recirculation indicator is Button /
the fan speed and airflow. on, air from the vehicle’s interior is This button turns the rear window
sent throughout the system again. defogger off and on (see page 74 ).
Temperature Control Dial When the indicator is off, air is
Turning this dial clockwise increases brought in from the outside of the On some models, this button also
the temperature of the airflow. vehicle (fresh air mode). operates the heated outside mirrors
(see page 105 ).

Features
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button The outside air intakes for the
If equipped heating and cooling system are at Mode Control
This button turns the air the base of the windshield. Keep this Use the mode control buttons to
conditioning on and off. The area clear of leaves and other debris. select the vents air flows from. Some
indicator in the button is on when air will flow from the dashboard
the A/C is on. The system should be left in fresh corner vents in all modes.
air mode under almost all conditions.
MAX A/C Button Keeping the system in recirculation Air flows from the center
If equipped mode, particularly with the A/C off, and corner vents in the dashboard.
The system automatically can cause the windows to fog up.
turns on the A/C and switches to Airflow is divided between
recirculation mode. Air flows from Switch to recirculation mode when the vents in the dashboard and the
the center and side vents in the driving through dusty or smoky floor vents.
dashboard. Pressing the , A/C, conditions, then return to fresh air
or any of the mode buttons cancels mode.
MAX A/C.

CONTINUED

115
07/07/11 15:23:04 31SVA620 0121 

Vents, Heating, and A/C

Air flows from the floor Air flows from the defroster Using the Heater
vents. vents at the base of the windshield. The heater uses engine coolant to
warm the air. If the engine is cold, it
When you select , the system When you select or , will be several minutes before you
automatically switches to fresh air the system automatically switches to feel warm air coming from the
mode. If you switch the mode from fresh air mode and turns on the A/C. system.
or to , the system You cannot turn the A/C off in this
keeps the A/C on. The A/C mode. 1. Select .
indicator will not come on if it was When you select , the system
off to start with. Ventilation automatically switches to fresh air
The flow-through ventilation system mode. If you switch the mode
To turn off the A/C, press the A/C draws in outside air, circulates it from or , the system
button to illuminate the indicator, through the interior, then exhausts it also automatically turns on the
then press it again to turn off the through vents near the rear window. A/C. This helps prevent the
A/C. windows from fogging up
1. Set the temperature to the lower unintendedly. The A/C indicator
When you switch to or limit. will not come on if it was off to
mode from , the A/C 2. Make sure the A/C is off. start with (see the first column on
turns off. But if it was on to start 3. Select and fresh air mode. this page).
with, the A/C stays on. 4. Set the fan to the desired speed. 2. Set the fan to the desired speed.
3. Adjust the warmth of the air with
Airflow is divided between the temperature control dial.
the floor vents and defroster vents at
the base of the windshield.

116
07/07/11 15:23:14 31SVA620 0122 

Vents, Heating, and A/C

Using the A/C If the interior is very warm, you can Dehumidify the Interior
Air conditioning places an extra load cool it down more rapidly by partially Air conditioning, as it cools, removes
on the engine. Watch the engine opening the windows, turning on the moisture from the air. When used in
coolant temperature gauge (see page air conditioning, and setting the fan combination with the heater, it
68 ). If it moves near the red zone, to maximum speed in fresh air mode. makes the interior warm and dry and
turn off the A/C until the gauge can prevent the windows from
reading returns to normal. To cool the interior with MAX A/C: fogging up.
1. Set the fan to the desired speed.

Features
1. Turn on the A/C by pressing the 2. Select MAX A/C. 1. Turn the fan on.
button. The indicator in the button The system automatically turns on 2. Turn on the air conditioning.
comes on when a fan speed is the A/C, selects , and 3. Select and fresh air mode.
selected. switches to recirculation mode. 4. Adjust the temperature to your
2. Make sure the temperature is set 3. Make sure the temperature is set preference.
to maximum cool. to maximum cool.
3. Select . This setting is suitable for all driving
4. If the outside air is humid, select conditions whenever the outside
recirculation mode. If the outside temperature is above 32°F (0°C).
air is dry, select fresh air mode.
5. Set the fan to the desired speed.

117
07/07/11 15:23:26 31SVA620 0123 

Vents, Heating, and A/C

To Defog and Defrost To Remove Exterior Frost or Ice To Turn Everything Off
To remove fog from the inside of the From the Windows Turning the fan speed control dial all
windows: 1. Select . The system the way to the left shuts the system
1. Set the fan to the desired speed, or automatically switches to fresh air off.
high for faster defrosting. mode and turns on the A/C.
2. Select . The system The A/C indicator does not come Keep the system off for short
automatically switches to fresh air on if it was off to start with. periods only.
mode and turns on the A/C. The 2. Select .
A/C indicator will not come on if it 3. Set the fan and temperature To keep stale air and mustiness
was off to start with. controls to maximum level. from collecting, you should have
3. Adjust the temperature so the the fan running at all times.
airflow feels warm. To clear the windows faster, you can
4. Select / to help clear the close the dashboard corner vents by
rear window. rotating the wheel next to each vent.
5. To increase airflow to the This sends more warm air to the
windshield, close the corner vents. windshield defroster vents. Once the
windshield is clear, select fresh air
When you switch to , from mode to avoid fogging the windows.
or , the A/C stays on.
This helps prevent the windows from For your safety, make sure you have
rapidly fogging up when the air is a clear view through all the windows
suddenly routed away from the before driving.
windshield. If you want to turn the
A/C off, press and release the A/C
button twice. The indicator in the
button comes on and then goes off.

118
07/07/11 15:23:34 31SVA620 0124 

Audio System

An audio system is standard on all


Models without navigation system
models except the U.S. DX. Read the U.S. LX model EX, EX-L and Si models
appropriate pages (as shown below) Canadian DX, DX-G, and LX models
to use your vehicle’s audio system.

For vehicles without navigation


system, see pages 120 through 137 .

Features
For vehicles with navigation system,
see pages 138 through 171 .

Models with navigation system


U.S. EX, EX-L and Si models

119
07/07/11 15:23:44 31SVA620 0125 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

EX, EX-L and Si models


Your audio system shows a welcome
message on the display when you
turn the ignition switch to the
ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)
position. You can see a message
‘‘WELCOME’’ on the display when
your vehicle was new.

You can also customize this welcome POWER/VOLUME TUNE KNOB


message to your liking with the KNOB
audio controls.
SEEK BUTTON
To Customize a Message EX model is shown.
You can set up to about 16
characters on the display. 3. Turn the TUNE knob to change a To change the letter, select the
letter. previous segment by pushing the
To select a character: bottom of the SEEK button.
4. Push the top of the SEEK button
1. Make sure the audio system is off. to select the next segment, then The system will return to the audio
turn the TUNE knob to select a display about 5 seconds after you
2. Push and hold the TUNE knob, letter. Repeat this procedure to set stop selecting a letter.
then push the power/volume knob your message.
on the audio control panel. You
will see the first letter blinking.

120
07/07/11 15:23:50 31SVA620 0126 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Playing the AM/FM Radio

U.S. LX and Canadian DX, DX-G and LX models EX, EX-L and Si models

SCAN AM FM A.SEL AM/FM BUTTON A.SEL (AUTO SELECT) BUTTON


BUTTON BUTTON BUTTON (AUTO SELECT)
BUTTON

Features
POWER/VOLUME PRESET SEEK/ TUNE KNOB POWER/VOLUME PRESET SEEK/ TUNE KNOB
KNOB BUTTONS SKIP KNOB BUTTONS SKIP
BUTTON BUTTON

121
07/07/11 15:23:57 31SVA620 0127 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

To Play the AM/FM Radio To Select a Station SCAN − The scan function samples
The ignition switch must be in the You can use any of five methods to all stations with strong signals on the
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. find radio stations on the selected selected band. To activate it, press
Turn the system on by pushing the band: tune, seek, scan, the preset the SCAN button, then release it.
power/volume knob or the AM or buttons, and auto select. You will see SCAN in the display.
FM button (the AM/FM button on The system will scan for a station
premium audio system). Adjust the TUNE − Use the TUNE knob to with a strong signal. When it finds
volume by turning the power/ tune the radio to a desired frequency. one, it will stop and play that station
volume knob. Turn the knob to the right to tune to for about 10 seconds.
a higher frequency, and turn it to the
The band and frequency that the left to tune to a lower frequency. If you do nothing, the system will
radio was last tuned to are displayed. then scan for the next strong station
To change bands, press the AM or SEEK − The seek function and play it for 10 seconds. When it
FM button (AM/FM button on searches up and down from the plays a station you want to listen to,
premium audio system). On the FM current frequency to find a station press the SCAN button again.
band, ST will be displayed if the with a strong signal. To activate it,
station is broadcasting in stereo. press the or side of the
Stereo reproduction in AM is not SEEK/SKIP button, then release it.
available.

122
07/07/11 15:24:06 31SVA620 0128 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Preset − Each side of the buttons AUTO SELECT − If you are If you do not like the stations auto
(1 through 6) can store one traveling far from home and can no select has stored, you can store
frequency on AM, and two longer receive your preset stations, other frequencies on the preset
frequencies on FM. you can use the auto select feature to buttons as previously described.
find stations in the local area.
1. Select the desired band, AM or To turn off auto select, press the
FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store Press the A. SEL button. You will see A. SEL (auto select) button. This
two frequencies with each side of A. SEL flashing in the display, and restores the presets you originally

Features
the preset button. the system goes into scan mode for set.
several seconds. It stores the
2. Use the tune, seek, or scan frequencies of six AM, and twelve For information on AM/FM radio
function to tune the radio to a FM stations in the preset buttons. frequencies and reception, see page
desired station. 172 .
You will see a ‘‘0’’ displayed after
3. Pick a preset number (1−6), and pressing a preset button if auto
hold it until you hear a beep. select cannot find a strong station for
every preset button.
4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a
total of six stations on AM and
twelve stations on FM.

123
07/07/11 15:24:18 31SVA620 0129 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Adjusting the Sound SVC − Adjusts the volume level choose low. If you feel the sound is
Press the TUNE (SOUND) knob based on the vehicle speed. too quiet, choose high.
repeatedly to display the BASS,
TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, Each mode is shown in the display as This function is set to MID as the
SUBWOOFER (if equipped), and it changes. Turn the TUNE knob to default setting when the vehicle
SVC (speed-sensitive volume adjust the setting to your liking. leaves the factory.
compensation) settings. When the level reaches the center,
you will see ‘‘C’’ in the display. Audio System Lighting
BASS − Adjusts the bass. You can use the instrument panel
The system will return to the audio brightness control buttons to adjust
TREBLE − Adjusts the treble. display about 5 seconds after you the illumination of the audio system
stop adjusting a mode. (see page 73 ). The audio system
FADER − Adjusts the front-to-back illuminates when the parking lights
strength of the sound. Speed-sensitive Volume are on, even if the radio is off.
Compensation (SVC)
BALANCE − Adjusts the side-to- The SVC mode controls the volume
side strength of the sound. based on vehicle speed. The faster
you go, the louder the audio volume
If equipped becomes. As you slow down, the
SUBWOOFER − Adjusts the audio volume decreases.
strength of sound from the
subwoofer speaker. The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF,
SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVC
HIGH. Turn the TUNE knob to
adjust the setting to your liking. If
you feel the sound is too loud,

124
07/07/11 15:24:24 31SVA620 0130 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Playing the XM Satellite Radio


Optional on U.S. EX, EX-L and Si
models POWER/VOLUME KNOB DISP BUTTON
Your audio system is capable of
receiving XM Satellite Radio SCAN BUTTON XM RADIO BUTTON
anywhere in the United States,
except Hawaii and Alaska.

Features
XM is a registered trademark of
XM Satellite Radio, Inc.

XM satellite radio receives signals


from two satellites to produce clear,
high-quality digital reception. It
offers many channels in several
categories. Along with a large
selection of different types of music,
XM satellite radio allows you to view
channel and category selections in
the display.

PRESET BUTTONS TUNE KNOB

SEEK/SKIP BUTTON

125
07/07/11 15:24:31 31SVA620 0131 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Operating the XM Radio MODE − To switch between You may experience periods when
To listen to XM radio, turn the channel mode and category mode, XM Radio does not transmit the
ignition switch to the ACCESSORY press and hold the DISP button until artist’s name and song title
(I) or the ON (II) position. Press the the mode changes. information. If this happens, there is
AUX button to select XM satellite In channel mode, you can select all nothing wrong with your system.
radio mode. Adjust the volume by of the available channels. In category
turning the knob. The last channel mode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, TUNE − Turn the TUNE knob to
you listened to will show in the etc., you can select all of the change channel selections. Turn the
display. channels within that category. knob right for higher numbered
Each time you press and release the channels and left for lower
DISP button, the display changes in numbered channels. In the category
the following sequence: Channel mode, you can only select channels
name, channel number, category, within that category.
artist name, and music title.
SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY) −
Press either side of the SEEK/SKIP
button ( or ) to select
another category.

126
07/07/11 15:24:42 31SVA620 0132 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

SCAN − The scan function gives 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan XM Radio Display Messages
you a sampling of all channels while function to tune to a desired
in the channel mode. In the category channel. ‘‘LOADING’’ − XM is loading the
mode, only the channels within that audio or program information.
category are scanned. To activate In category mode, only channels
scan, press the SCAN button. The within that category can be selected. ‘‘OFF AIR’’ − The channel
system plays each channel in In channel mode, all channels can be currently selected is no longer
numerical order for a few seconds, selected. broadcasting.

Features
then selects the next channel. When
you hear a channel you want to 3. Pick a preset number you want for ‘‘UPDATING’’ − The encryption
continue listening to, press the that channel. Press and hold the code is being updated. Wait until the
button again. button until you hear a beep. encryption code is fully updated.
Channels 0 and 1 should still work
Preset − You can store up to 12 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the normally.
preset channels using each side of first six channels.
the preset button. Each side of the ‘‘NO SIGNAL’’ − The signal is
button stores one channel from the 5. Press the AUX button again. Store currently too weak. Move the vehicle
XM1 band and one channel from the the next six channels using steps 2 to an area away from tall buildings,
XM2 band. and 3. and with an unobstructed view of the
southern horizon.
To store a channel: Once a channel is stored, press and
release the proper side of the preset
1. Press the AUX button. Either XM1 button to tune to it.
or XM2 will show in the display.

CONTINUED

127
07/07/11 15:24:47 31SVA620 0133 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

‘‘ - - - - ’’ − The selected channel


number does not exist, or is not part Signal may be blocked by Signal weaker in
of your subscription, or this channel mountains or large obstacles to these areas.
the south.
has no artist or title information at
this time.

‘‘ANTENNA’’ − There is a problem


with the XM antenna. Please consult
your dealer.

SATELLITE

GROUND REPEATER

The XM satellites are in orbit over Satellite signals are more likely to be
the equator; therefore, objects south blocked by tall buildings and
of the vehicle may cause satellite mountains the farther north you
reception interruptions. To help travel from the equator. Carrying
compensate for this, ground-based large items on a roof rack can also
repeaters are placed in major block the signal.
metropolitan areas.

128
07/07/11 15:24:58 31SVA620 0134 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Depending on where you drive, you As required by the FCC: knob until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display.
may experience reception problems. Changes or modifications not expressly Your I.D. will appear in the display.
Interference can be caused by any of approved by the party responsible for
these conditions: compliance could void the user’s After you’ve registered with XM
authority to operate the equipment. Radio, keep your audio system in the
Driving on the north side of an satellite radio mode while you wait
east/west mountain road. Receiving Satellite Radio Service for activation. This should take about
Driving on the north side of a If your XM Radio service has expired 30 minutes.

Features
large commercial truck on an or you purchased your vehicle from
east/west road. a previous owner, you can listen to a While waiting for activation, make
Driving in tunnels. sampling of the broadcasts available sure your vehicle remains in an open
Driving on a road beside a vertical on XM Satellite Radio. With the area with good reception. Once your
wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south ignition switch in the ACCESSORY audio system is activated, you’ll be
of you. (I) or ON (II) position, push the able to listen to XM radio broadcasts.
Driving on the lower level of a power/volume knob to turn on the XM Radio will continue to send an
multi-tiered road. audio system and press the AUX activation signal to your vehicle for
Driving on a single lane road button. A variety of music types and at least 12 hours from the activation
alongside dense trees taller than styles will play. request. If the service has not been
50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you. activated after 36 hours, contact XM
Large items carried on a roof rack. If you decide to purchase XM Radio.
satellite radio service, contact XM
There may be other geographic Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at
situations that could affect XM radio 1-800-852-9696. You will need to give
reception. them your radio I.D. number and
your credit card number. To get your
radio I.D. number, turn the TUNE

129
07/07/11 15:25:05 31SVA620 0135 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Playing a Disc

U.S. LX model EX, EX-L and Si models


Canadian DX, DX-G and LX models
EJECT BUTTON RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON CD BUTTON EJECT LOAD INDICATOR CD BUTTON
RDM BUTTON RPT (REPEAT) RDM DISP
LOAD INDICATOR (RANDOM) DISP (RANDOM)
BUTTON BUTTON BUTTON
BUTTON BUTTON

SCAN SCAN
BUTTON BUTTON

SEEK/SKIP BUTTON SEEK/SKIP BUTTON

POWER/VOLUME KNOB TUNE KNOB POWER/VOLUME KNOB TUNE KNOB

130
07/07/11 15:25:19 31SVA620 0136 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

To Play a Disc NOTE: The specifications of the compatible


To load or play discs, the ignition If a file on an MP3 or WMA disc is WMA file are:
switch must be in the ACCESSORY protected by digital rights −Sampling frequency:
(I) or ON (II) position. management (DRM), the audio unit 22.05/32/44.1/48 kHz
displays FORMAT, and then skips to −Bit rate:
You operate the disc player with the the next file. 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
same controls used for the radio. To −Compatible with variable bit rate
select the disc player, press the CD/ Video CDs and DVD discs do not and multi-session

Features
AUX button (the CD button on work in this unit. −Maximum layers
premium audio system). You will see (including ROOT): 8 layers
‘‘CD’’ in the display. The specifications of the compatible
MP3 file are: To Load a Disc
−Sampling frequency: Insert a disc about halfway into the
32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) disc slot. The drive will pull the disc
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. 24/22.05/16 kHz (MPEG2) in the rest of the way to play it. You
The label can curl up and cause the −Bit rate: operate the disc player with the
disc to jam in the unit. 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ same controls used for the radio.
160/192/224/256/320 kbps The number of the current track and
This audio system can also play (MPEG1) the elapsed time are shown in the
CD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed in 8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ display. When playing a disc in MP3
MP3 or WMA formats. When 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2) or WMA, the numbers of the current
playing a disc in MP3, you will see −Compatible with variable bit rate folder and file, and the elapsed time
‘‘MP3’’ in the display. In WMA and multi-session are shown. The system will
format, ‘‘WMA’’ will appear in the −Maximum layers continuously play a disc until you
display. You can select up to 255 (including ROOT): 8 layers change modes.
folders or tracks. CONTINUED

131
07/07/11 15:25:30 31SVA620 0137 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

You cannot load and play 3-inch the display. Press and hold the DISP To Change or Select Tracks/Files
(8-cm) discs in this system. button until the next 16 characters Use the SEEK/SKIP button while a
are shown. disc is playing to select passages and
Text Data Display Function change tracks (files in MP3/WMA
Each time you press the DISP button, You will also see some text data mode).
the display shows you the text data under these conditions:
on a disc, if the disc was recorded SEEK/SKIP − Each time you
with text data. When a new folder, file, or track is press and release the side of
selected. the SEEK/SKIP button, the player
You can see the album, artist, and skips forward to the beginning of the
track name in the display. If a disc is When you change the audio mode next track (file in MP3 or WMA
recorded in MP3 or WMA, you can to play a disc with text data or in mode). Press and release the
see the folder and file name, and the MP3 or WMA. side to skip backward to the
album, artist, and track tag. beginning of the current track. Press
When you insert a disc, and the it again to skip to the beginning of
With the folder name, you will see system begins to play. the previous track.
the FOLDER indicator in the display.
The TRACK indicator is shown with When playing a CD-DA with text To move rapidly within a track, press
the file or track name. data, the album and track name are and hold the or side of the
shown in the display. With a disc in SEEK/SKIP button.
The display shows up to about 16 MP3 or WMA, the display shows the
characters of selected text data (the folder and file name.
folder name, file name, etc.). If the
text data has more than 16
characters, you will see the first 15
characters and the > indicator in

132
07/07/11 15:25:39 31SVA620 0138 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

In MP3 or WMA mode You will hear a beep and see F-RPT In MP3 or WMA mode
FOLDER SELECTION − To in the display. The system FOLDER-RANDOM − This
select a different folder, turn the continuously replays the current feature, when activated, plays all
TUNE knob to move to the folder. Press the RPT button again to files in each folder in random order.
beginning of the next folder. Turn turn it off. Pressing the RDM button, To activate folder random, press the
the knob to the right until it clicks or selecting a different folder with RDM button 2 times. You will hear a
once to skip to the next folder, and to the TUNE knob also turns off the beep and see F-RDM in the display.
the left to move to the beginning of repeat feature. The system will then select and play

Features
the previous folder. Turning the files randomly. This continues until
TUNE knob more than two clicks Each time you press and release the you deactivate folder random by
skips several folders. RPT button, the mode changes from pressing the RDM button again, or
file repeat to folder repeat, then to by selecting a different folder with
REPEAT (TRACK/FILE normal playing. the TUNE knob.
REPEAT) − To continuously replay
a track (files in MP3 or WMA mode), RANDOM (Random within a Each time you press and release the
press and release the RPT button. disc/folder) − This feature plays RDM button, the mode changes
You will see RPT in the display. the tracks within a disc (the files from folder random play to random
Press and hold the RPT button for 2 within a folder in MP3 or WMA play (within a folder random play),
seconds to turn it off. mode) in random order. To activate then to normal playing.
random play, press and release the
In MP3 or WMA mode RDM button. In MP3 or WMA mode,
FOLDER-REPEAT − This feature, press the RDM button repeatedly to
when activated, replays all files on select RDM (within a folder random
the selected folder in the order they play). You will see RDM in the
are compressed. To activate folder display. Press the RDM button for 2
repeat, press the RPT button twice. seconds to return to normal play. CONTINUED

133
07/07/11 15:25:48 31SVA620 0139 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN) − In MP3 or WMA mode To Stop Playing a Disc


The scan function samples all tracks F-SCAN (FOLDER SCAN) − This Press the eject button ( ) to
(files in MP3 or WMA) on the disc in feature, when activated, samples the remove the disc. If you eject the disc,
the order they are recorded on the first file of each folder on the disc. but do not remove it from the slot,
disc. To activate scan, press the To activate folder scan, press the the system will automatically reload
SCAN button. In MP3 or WMA SCAN button twice. You will see it after 10 seconds and put it in pause
mode, press the SCAN button F-SCAN in the display. mode. To begin playing, press the
repeatedly to select SCAN. You will CD button.
see SCAN in the display. You will get The system plays the first file in the
a 10 second sampling of each track/ first folder for about 10 seconds. If You can also eject the disc when the
file on the disc. Press the SCAN you do nothing, the system will then ignition switch is off.
button again to get out of scan mode play the first files in the remaining
and play the last track/file sampled. folders for 10 seconds each. After To play the radio when a disc is
playing the first file of the last folder, playing, press the AM or FM button
Pressing either side of the SEEK/ the system plays normally. (the AM/FM button or XM button
SKIP button also turns off the scan on models that are XM radio
feature. Pressing either side of the SEEK/ capable). Press the CD button again
SKIP button, selecting a different to switch back to the disc player.
folder with the TUNE knob, or
pressing the SCAN button, also turns
off the folder scan.

Each time you press and release the


SCAN button, the mode changes
from folder scan to scan, then to
normal playing.

134
07/07/11 15:25:54 31SVA620 0140 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

If you turn the system off while a Operating the Optional Disc If you select an empty slot in the
disc is playing, either with the Changer magazine, the changer will search
power/volume knob or by turning An optional six or eight disc changer for the next available disc to load and
off the ignition switch, the disc will is available for your vehicle. This play.
stay in the drive. When you turn the disc changer uses the same controls
system back on, the disc will begin used for the in-dash disc player or Protecting Discs
playing where it left off. the radio. For information on how to handle
and protect compact discs, see page

Features
Load the desired discs in the 174 .
magazine, and load the magazine in
the changer according to the
instructions that came with the unit.

To select the disc changer, press the


CD button. The disc and track
numbers will be displayed. To select
a different disc, use the preset 4
(DISC −) or the preset 1 (DISC +)
on the preset button. To select the
previous disc, press the preset 4
(DISC −), or the preset 1 (DISC +)
to select the next disc in sequence.

135
07/07/11 15:26:03 31SVA620 0141 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Disc Player Error Messages


The chart on the right explains the Error Cause Solution
error messages you may see in the Message
display while playing a disc. UNSUPPORT Track/File format not Current track will skipped. The next supported
FORMAT supported track or file plays automatically.
If you see an error message in the BAD DISC Press the eject button and pull out the disc(s).
display while playing a disc, press PLEASE CHECK Check the disc for serious damage, signs of
the eject button. After ejecting the OWNERS Mechanical Error deformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt
disc, check it for damage or MANUAL (see page 175). Insert the disc again. If the code
deformation. If there is no damage, PUSH EJECT does not disappear, or the disc(s) cannot be
insert the disc again. BAD DISC removed, consult your dealer. Do not try to
For the additional information on PLEASE CHECK TOC Error force the disc out of the player.
damaged discs, see page 175 . OWNERS FOCUS Error
MANUAL
If there is still a problem, the error
message will appear again. Press the The ejected disc will not be reloaded automatically.
eject button, and pull out the disc.

Insert a different disc. If the new


disc plays, there is a problem with
the first disc. If the error message
cycle repeats and you cannot clear it,
take your vehicle to a dealer.

136
07/07/11 15:26:13 31SVA620 0142 

Audio System (Models without navigation system)

Optional Disc Changer Error


Messages Error Cause Solution
The chart on the right explains the Message
error messages you may see in the Press the magazine eject button, and pull the
display while playing a disc. FOCUS Error magazine out. If the message does not
disappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,
If you see an error message in the see your dealer.
display while playing a disc, press No disc in the disc Insert disc.

Features
the eject button. After ejecting the magazine
disc, check it for damage or Press the magazine eject button, pull the
deformation. If there is no damage, magazine out, check for an error message, then
insert the disc again. Mechanical Error insert the magazine again. If the message does
For the additional information on not disappear, or the magazine cannot be pulled
damaged discs, see page 175 . out, see your dealer.
No disc magazine in the Insert disc magazine.
If there is still a problem, the error disc changer
message will appear again. Press the High Temperature Will disappear when the temperature returns to
eject button, and pull out the disc. normal.

Insert a different disc. If the new


disc plays, there is a problem with
the first disc. If the error message
cycle repeats and you cannot clear it,
take your vehicle to a dealer.

137
07/07/11 15:26:20 31SVA620 0143 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Voice Control System Playing the AM/FM Radio


In addition to the standard audio
controls, the audio system in your U.S. EX, EX-L, Si
vehicle can be operated using the
voice control system. See the FM2 ICON
navigation section in your Quick
Start Guide for an overview of this FM1 ICON AM ICON
system, and the Navigation System
Manual for complete details.

AM/FM
BUTTON
AUTO SELECT
AUDIO ICON
BUTTON BACKGROUND
SCAN ICON
BUTTON SOUND ICON

TUNE BAR PRESET BUTTONS

138
07/07/11 15:26:28 31SVA620 0144 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

To Play the AM/FM Radio The band and frequency that the To Select a Station
The ignition switch must be in the radio was last tuned to are displayed. You can use any of five methods to
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. To change bands, press the AM/FM find radio stations on the selected
Turn the system on by pushing the button, or touch the desired band band: tune, seek, scan, the preset
power/volume knob or the AM/FM icon (FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2). buttons, and auto select.
button. Adjust the volume by turning On the FM band, STEREO will be
the power/volume knob. displayed if the station is TUNE − Use the TUNE bar to tune
broadcasting in stereo. Stereo the radio to a desired frequency.

Features
Pushing the AUDIO button will also reproduction on AM is not available. Press the ▲ side of the bar to tune
turn on the system. to a higher frequency, and press the
For information on XM radio, see ▼ side to tune to a lower
You can also operate the audio page 142 . frequency.
system without using the control
icons on the audio screen. Use the Press and hold the ▲ or ▼ side of
control buttons on the left side of the the TUNE bar until you hear two
screen. The status bar appears on beeps to change the frequency
the bottom of the screen each time rapidly. Release the bar when the
you operate any of the control display reaches the desired
buttons. On the navigation screen, frequency.
you can also see audio information
by touching the AUDIO INFO icon
on the lower of the screen.

CONTINUED

139
07/07/11 15:26:37 31SVA620 0145 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

SEEK − The seek function If you do nothing, the system will Each preset button’s frequency is
searches up and down from the then scan for the next strong station shown on the bottom of the audio
current frequency to find a station and play it for 10 seconds. When it display.
with a strong signal. To activate it, plays a station you want to listen to,
press and hold the ▲ or ▼ side of press the SCAN button again.
the TUNE bar until you hear a beep,
then release it. Preset − Each preset button can
store one frequency on AM and two
SCAN − The scan function samples frequencies on FM.
all stations with strong signals on the
selected band. To activate it, press 1. Select the desired band, AM or
the SCAN button, then release it. FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store
You will see SCAN in the display. two frequencies with each preset
The system will scan for a station button.
with a strong signal. When it finds
one, it will stop and play that station 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan
for about 10 seconds. function to tune the radio to a
desired station.

3. Pick a preset button, and hold it


until you hear a beep.

4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a


total of six stations on AM and
twelve stations on FM.

140
07/07/11 15:26:42 31SVA620 0146 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

AUTO SELECT − If you are You will see a ‘‘0’’ displayed after
traveling far from home and can no pressing a preset button if auto
longer receive your preset stations, select cannot find a strong station for
you can use the auto select feature to every preset button.
find stations in the local area.
If you do not like the stations auto
Press the AUDIO button to view the select has stored, you can store
audio control icons, then press the other frequencies on the preset

Features
AUTO SEL icon. You will see AUTO buttons as previously described.
SEL flashing in the display, and the
system goes into scan mode for To turn off auto select, press the
several seconds. It stores the AUTO SEL icon. This restores the
frequencies of six AM, and twelve presets you originally set.
FM stations in the preset buttons.
For information on AM/FM radio
frequencies and reception, see page
172 .

141
07/07/11 15:26:48 31SVA620 0147 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)


Playing the XM Satellite Radio

XM RADIO ICON MODE ICON

POWER/VOLUME JOYSTICK
KNOB

CATEGORY
INDICATOR

AM/FM BUTTON
CD/XM (XM RADIO)
BUTTON

AUDIO BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
PRESET CHANNEL
NUMBER

TUNE BAR PRESET BUTTONS

142
07/07/11 15:26:55 31SVA620 0148 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Your audio system is capable of Operating the XM Radio MODE − To switch between
receiving XM Satellite Radio To listen to XM radio, turn the channel mode and category mode,
anywhere in the United States, ignition switch to the ACCESSORY touch the MODE icon. In channel
except Hawaii and Alaska. (I) or the ON (II) position. Press the mode, you can select all of the
CD/XM button to select XM satellite available channels. In category mode,
XM is a registered trademark of radio. Adjust the volume by turning such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc.,
XM Satellite Radio, Inc. the knob. The last channel you you can select all of the channels
listened to will show in the display. within that category. Each time you

Features
XM radio receives signals from two touch and release the MODE icon,
satellites to produce clear, high- You can also change to the XM radio the display changes between the
quality digital reception. It offers while you are listening to an FM channel mode and the category
many channels in several categories. station, AM station, disc, pc card, etc., mode.
Along with a large selection of by touching the XM1 or XM2 icon on
different types of music, XM radio the audio display.
allows you to view channel and
category selections in the display. You can also operate the radio using
When you press and hold the the control buttons on the left side of
AUDIO button, the display also the screen. The status bar appears
shows all XM information. on the bottom of the screen each
time you press any of the control
buttons. On the navigation screen,
you can also see the audio
information by touching the AUDIO
INFO icon on the lower of the screen.

CONTINUED

143
07/07/11 15:27:05 31SVA620 0149 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

TUNE − Press the TUNE bar to Preset − You can store up to 12


change channel selections. Press preset channels using each preset
▲ for higher numbered channels button or preset icons on the screen.
and ▼ for lower numbered Each preset button or icon stores
channels. In the category mode, you one channel from the XM1 band and
can only select channels within that one channel from the XM2 band.
category.
To store a channel:
CATEGORY − Press and hold
either side of the TUNE bar 1. Press the XM button. Either XM1
( or ) until you hear a beep or XM2 will show in the display.
to select another category.
2. Use the tune, seek, or scan
On the audio display, you will see the SCAN − The scan function gives function to tune to a desired
selected CHANNEL (number), you a sampling of all channels while channel.
CATEGORY, NAME (artist name), in the channel mode. In the category
and TITLE (music title). mode, only the channels within that In category mode, only channels
category are scanned. To activate within that category can be selected.
You may experience periods when scan, press the SCAN button or In channel mode, all channels can be
XM Radio does not transmit the touch the SCAN icon on the screen. selected.
artist’s name and song title The system plays each channel in
information. If this happens, there is numerical order for a few seconds, 3. Pick the preset button (icon) you
nothing wrong with your system. then selects the next channel. When want for that channel. Press and
you hear a channel you want to listen hold the button (icon) until you
to, press the button or touch the icon hear a beep.
again.

144
07/07/11 15:27:15 31SVA620 0150 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the XM Radio Display Messages ‘‘NO SIGNAL’’ − The signal is
first six channels. currently too weak. Move the vehicle
‘‘LOADING’’ − XM is loading the to an area away from tall buildings,
5. Press the XM button again or audio or program information. and with an unobstructed view of the
touch the other XM icon (XM1 or southern horizon.
XM2) on the audio display. Store ‘‘OFF AIR’’ − The channel
the next six channels using steps 2 currently selected is no longer ‘‘ - - - - ’’ − The selected channel
and 3. broadcasting. number does not exist or is not part

Features
of your subscription.
Once a channel is stored, press and ‘‘UPDATING’’ − The encryption
release the proper preset button code is being updated. Wait until the ‘‘NO INFO’’ − This channel has no
(icon) to tune to it. Each preset encryption code is fully updated. artist or title information at this time.
button’s channel is shown on the Channels 0 and 1 should still work
bottom of the audio display. normally. ‘‘ANTENNA’’ − There is a problem
with the XM antenna. Please consult
your dealer.

CONTINUED

145
07/07/11 15:29:16 31SVA620 0151 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

The XM satellites are in orbit over


Signal may be blocked by Signal weaker in the equator; therefore, objects south
mountains or large obstacles to these areas. of the vehicle may cause satellite
the south. reception interruptions. To help
compensate for this, ground-based
repeaters are placed in major
metropolitan areas.

Satellite signals are more likely to be


blocked by tall buildings and
mountains the farther north you
travel from the equator. Carrying
large items on a roof rack can also
block the signal.

SATELLITE

GROUND REPEATER

146
07/07/11 15:29:27 31SVA620 0152 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Depending on where you drive, you As required by the FCC: bar until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display.
may experience reception problems. Changes or modifications not expressly Your I.D. will appear in the display.
Interference can be caused by any of approved by the party responsible for
these conditions: compliance could void the user’s After you’ve registered with XM
authority to operate the equipment. Radio, keep your audio system in the
Driving on the north side of an satellite radio mode while you wait
east/west mountain road. Receiving Satellite Radio Service for activation. This should take about
Driving on the north side of a If your XM Radio service has expired 30 minutes.

Features
large commercial truck on an or you purchased your vehicle from
east/west road. a previous owner, you can listen to a While waiting for activation, make
Driving in tunnels. sampling of the broadcasts available sure your vehicle remains in an open
Driving on a road beside a vertical on XM Satellite Radio. With the area with good reception. Once your
wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south ignition switch in the ACCESSORY audio system is activated, you’ll be
of you. (I) or ON (II) position, push the able to listen to XM radio broadcasts.
Driving on the lower level of a power/volume knob to turn on the XM Radio will continue to send an
multi-tiered road. audio system and press the CD/XM activation signal to your vehicle for
Driving on a single lane road button. A variety of music types and at least 12 hours from the activation
alongside dense trees taller than styles will play. request. If the service has not been
50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you. activated after 36 hours, contact XM
Large items carried on a roof rack. If you decide to purchase XM Radio.
Satellite Radio service, contact XM
There may be other geographic Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at
situations that could affect XM radio 1-800-852-9696. You will need to give
reception. them your radio I.D. number and
your credit card number. To get your
radio I.D. number, press the TUNE

147
07/07/11 15:29:39 31SVA620 0153 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Adjusting the Sound BALANCE − Adjusts the side-to-


side strength of the sound.
SPEAKER SETTING To adjust the left/right balance,
touch the L or R icon.

SUBWOOFER − Adjusts the


strength of sound from the
subwoofer speaker. To adjust the
sound strength, touch or
on each side of the adjustment
bar.
BASS/TREBLE SETTING
SOUND ICON The right upper display shows you
BASS − Adjusts the bass. the current setting of the sound
You can adjust the sound on the TREBLE − Adjusts the treble. To strength coming from each speaker.
navigation screen. To adjust the adjust the treble and bass, touch
sound, push the AUDIO button, then or on each side of the SVC (speed-sensitive volume
enter the sound grid by touching the treble or bass adjustment bar. The compensation) − The SVC mode
SOUND icon on the display. adjustment bar on the right lower controls the volume based on vehicle
display shows you the current speed. The faster you go, the louder
setting. the audio volume becomes. As you
slow down, the audio volume
FADER − Adjusts the front-to-back decreases. Touch the appropriate
strength of the sound. To adjust the icon (Low, Mid, Hi, Off) to select the
front/rear fader, touch the FR or RR mode.
icon.

148
07/07/11 15:29:46 31SVA620 0154 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

This function is set to MID as the Screen Mode Audio System Lighting
default setting when the vehicle You can select the background You can use the instrument panel
leaves the factory. If you feel the screen to display the sound level. brightness control buttons to adjust
sound is too loud, choose low. If you There are three screen modes: level the illumination of the audio system
feel the sound is too quiet, choose Hi. (the sound level is shown with the (see page 73 ). The audio system
vertical bars), spectrum analysis (the illuminates when the parking lights
You can also select the icon with the sound level appears as ripples of are on, even if the radio is off.
joystick. Move it up and down to water), and off. Each time you touch

Features
move the highlighting and scroll the background icon, the display
through lists. Select the icon, then changes.
move the joystick to left or right to
change the setting.

The system will return to the audio


display about 5 seconds after you
stop adjusting a mode.

149
07/07/11 15:29:51 31SVA620 0155 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)


Playing a Disc

CD ICON

POWER/VOLUME JOYSTICK
KNOB

OPEN BUTTON

CD BUTTON

AUDIO BUTTON

SCAN BUTTON

TUNE BAR

RDM (RANDOM) FAST FORWARD SKIP+BUTTON


BUTTON BUTTON
RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON REWIND BUTTON SKIP−BUTTON

150
07/07/11 15:30:03 31SVA620 0156 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

To Play a Disc Video CDs and DVD discs do not The specifications for compatible
You operate the disc player with the work in this unit. WMA files are:
same controls used for the radio. To −Sampling frequency:
load or play discs, the ignition switch The specifications for compatible 22.05/32/44.1/48 kHz
must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or MP3 files are: −Bit rate:
ON (II) position. −Sampling frequency: 32/40/48/64/80/96/128/160/
32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 192 kbps
24/22.05/16 kHz (MPEG2) −Compatible with variable bit rate

Features
−Bit rate: and multi-session
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ −Maximum layers
The label can curl up and cause the 160/192/224/256/320 kbps (including ROOT): 8 layers
disc to jam in the unit. (MPEG1)
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ NOTE:
This audio system can also play CD- 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2) If a file on an MP3 or WMA disc is
Rs and CD-RWs compressed in MP3 −Compatible with variable bit rate protected by digital rights
or WMA formats. When playing a and multi-session management (DRM), the audio unit
disc in MP3, you will see ‘‘MP3’’ on −Maximum layers displays CD FORMAT, and then
the screen. In WMA format, ‘‘WMA’’ (including ROOT): 8 layers skips to the next file.
will appear on the screen. You can
select up to 99 folders and play up to
999 tracks. If the disc has a complex
structure, it takes a while to read the
disc before the system begins to play
it.

CONTINUED

151
07/07/11 15:30:11 31SVA620 0157 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

To Load a Disc

DISC SLOT

OPEN BUTTON CLOSE BUTTON

The disc player is behind the Insert a disc about halfway into the To return the screen to the upright
navigation screen. To use the disc disc slot. The drive will pull the disc position, press the CLOSE button on
player, press the OPEN button in the rest of the way and begin to the edge of the screen panel. Do not
beside the screen. The screen folds play it. use the folded screen as a tray. If
back, and the disc player appears. you put a cup, for example, on the
You cannot load and play 3-inch screen, the liquid inside the cup may
(8-cm) discs in this system. spill on the screen when you go over
a bump.

152
07/07/11 15:30:19 31SVA620 0158 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Push the AUDIO button beside the To Change or Select Tracks/Files You can also select an icon with the
screen to show the audio display and joystick. Move it to left, right, up, or
operate the disc player. PRESET BUTTON’S FUNCTION down to change the highlighting and
scroll through lists. Then press the
You can also operate the audio ENT on the top of the joystick to
system without using the control select the icon.
icons on the audio screen. Press the
CD button. The status bar appears SKIP − Each time you press and

Features
on the bottom of the screen. On the release (preset 6), the player
navigation screen, you can see the skips forward to the beginning of the
audio information whenever you next track (file in MP3 or WMA
touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the mode). Press and release
lower portion of the screen. PRESET BUTTONS (preset 5), to skip backward to
the beginning of the current track.
When playing a CD recorded with You can use the preset buttons while Press it again to skip to the
text data, the track, album, and artist a disc is playing to select passages beginning of the previous track.
name are shown on the audio display. and change tracks (files in MP3 or
When playing a disc in MP3 or WMA, WMA mode). Each preset button’s FF/REW − To move rapidly within
the folder number and name, the file function is shown on the bottom of a track/file, press and hold
number and name, the artist name, the screen. (preset 4) or (preset 3).
and the elapsed time are shown. The
system will continuously play a disc
until you change modes. If the disc
was not recorded with text data, it
will not be displayed.
CONTINUED

153
07/07/11 15:30:26 31SVA620 0159 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

In MP3 or WMA mode In MP3 or WMA mode In MP3 or WMA mode


FOLDER SELECTION − To FOLDER REPEAT − This feature, FOLDER RANDOM − This
select a different folder, press either when activated, replays all files on feature, when activated, plays all
side of the TUNE bar to move to the the selected folder in the order they files in each folder in random order,
beginning of the next folder. Press are compressed. To activate folder rather than in the order they are
the ▲ side of the TUNE bar to skip repeat, press and hold the RPT compressed. To activate folder
to the next folder, and the ▼ side to button (preset 1). You will see random, press the RDM button
move to the beginning of the FOLDER REPEAT in the display. (preset 2) twice. You will see
previous folder. The system continuously replays the FOLDER RANDOM in the display.
current folder. Press the RPT button The system then selects and plays
TRACK REPEAT (FILE again to turn it off. Pressing the files randomly. This continues until
REPEAT) − To continuously replay RDM button or selecting a different you deactivate folder random by
a track (file in MP3 or WMA mode), folder with the TUNE bar also turns pressing the RDM button again, or if
press and release the RPT button off folder repeat. you select a different folder with the
(preset 1). You will see TRACK TUNE bar.
REPEAT in the display. Press and TRACK RANDOM (Random
hold the RPT button for 2 seconds to within a disc/folder) − This
turn it off. feature plays the tracks within a disc
(the files within a folder) in random
order. To activate track random,
press and release the RDM button
(preset 2). You will see TRACK
RANDOM in the display. Press and
hold the RDM button for 2 seconds
to return to normal play.

154
07/07/11 15:30:35 31SVA620 0160 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN) − In MP3 or WMA mode Using a Track List


The scan function samples all tracks FOLDER SCAN − This feature,
(files in MP3 or WMA) in the order when activated, samples all the first FOLDER ICON TRACK/FILE ICON
they were recorded. To activate scan, files in each folder on the disc in
press and release the SCAN button. order. To activate folder scan, press
You will see TRACK SCAN in the and hold the SCAN button. You will
display. You will get a 10 second see FOLDER SCAN in the display.
sampling of each track/file on the

Features
disc. Press and hold the SCAN The system plays the first file in
button for 2 seconds to get out of each folder for about 10 seconds. If
scan mode and play the last track/ you do nothing, the system then
file sampled. plays the first file in each folder for
10 seconds each. After playing the FOLDER NUMBER RETURN ICON
Pressing either SKIP button (preset first file of the last folder, the system
5 or 6) also turns off scan. goes to normal playing. You can also select a track/file
directly from a track list on the audio
Pressing either SKIP button (preset display. Press the AUDIO button to
5 or 6), or selecting a different folder show the audio display, then touch
with the TUNE bar, or pressing the the Track List icon. The track list
SCAN button, also turns off folder menu appears on the display.
scan.

CONTINUED

155
07/07/11 15:30:44 31SVA620 0161 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

When playing a CD recorded with To Stop Playing a Disc Removing a Disc


text data, each track name is shown To play the radio when a disc is To remove a disc from the audio unit,
on the audio display. With a disc playing, press the AM/FM button or fold back the screen by pressing the
recorded in MP3 or WMA, the folder touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or OPEN button (see page 152 ). Press
number and the location are also XM2 icon. If a PC card is in the audio the disc eject button ( ) to
displayed. unit, touch the CARD icon to play remove the disc. If you eject the disc,
the PC card. Press the CD button but do not remove it from the slot,
If the disc was not recorded with text again or touch the CD icon to switch the system will automatically reload
data, only the track number is shown. back to the disc player. it after 10 seconds and put it in pause
mode. To begin playing, press the
To scroll through the display, touch If you turn the system off while a CD button.
the ▲ or ▼ icon on the side of the disc is playing, either with the
screen. To go back to the previous power/volume knob or by turning To return the screen to the upright
display, touch the Return icon on the off the ignition switch, the disc will position, press the CLOSE button.
screen. stay in the drive. When you turn the
system back on, the disc will begin You cannot close the screen if a disc
Select the desired track/file by playing where it left off. is partially inserted into its slot.
touching the icon on the display. The
selected icon will be highlighted in You can also eject the disc when the
blue. The system begins to play the ignition switch is off.
selected track/file. With a disc in
MP3 or WMA, touch the folder icon
on the upper left of the screen to
move to the parent folder. The
current folder is highlighted in blue.

156
07/07/11 15:30:50 31SVA620 0162 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Operating the Optional Disc Protecting Discs


Changer For information on how to handle
An optional six or eight disc changer and protect discs, see page 174 .
is available for your vehicle. This
disc changer uses the same controls
used for the in-dash disc player or
the radio.

Features
Load the desired discs in the
magazine, and load the magazine in
the changer according to the
instructions that came with the unit.

To select the disc changer, press the


CD/AUX button. The disc and track
numbers will be displayed. To select
a different disc, use either side of the
TUNE bar. To select the previous
disc, press the ▲ side. To select the
next disc, press the ▼ side.

If you select an empty slot in the


magazine, the changer will search
for the next available disc to load and
play.

157
07/07/11 15:31:00 31SVA620 0163 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Disc Player Error Messages


The chart on the right explains the Error Cause Solution
error messages you may see in the Message
display while playing a disc. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.
Check if it is inserted correctly in the disc
If you see an error message in the FOCUS Error player.
display while playing a disc, press Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged
the eject button. After ejecting the (see page 175).
disc, check it for damage or Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.
deformation. If there is no damage, Check the disc for damage or deformation (see
insert the disc again. Mechanical Error page 175).
For the additional information on If the disc cannot be pulled out, or the error
damaged discs, see page 175 . message does not disappear after the disc is
ejected, see your dealer.
If there is still a problem, the error Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.
message will appear again. Press the TOC Error Check the disc for damage or deformation (see
eject button, and pull out the disc. page 175).
High Temperature Will disappear when the temperature returns to
Insert a different disc. If the new normal.
disc plays, there is a problem with
the first disc. If the error message
cycle repeats and you cannot clear it,
take your vehicle to a dealer.

158
07/07/11 15:31:06 31SVA620 0164 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Playing a PC Card
TRACK LIST ICON PC CARD ICON

JOYSTICK
POWER/VOLUME
KNOB

Features
PLAY MODE
OPEN BUTTON ICON

CD/XM BUTTON

AUDIO BUTTON

SCAN BUTTON

TUNE BAR

RDM (RANDOM) FAST FORWARD SKIP + BUTTON


BUTTON BUTTON
RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON REWIND BUTTON SKIP − BUTTON

159
07/07/11 15:31:18 31SVA620 0165 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

To Play a PC card Always use the recommended Never insert foreign objects into
You operate the PC card player with memory card with the appropriate the PC card slot.
the same controls used for the radio adapter (if an adapter is needed).
and the disc player. To load or play a Some memory cards will not work in The specifications for compatible
card, the ignition switch must be in this unit. MP3 files are:
the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) −Sampling frequency:
position. NOTE: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1)
When you insert a PC card into 24/22.05/16 kHz (MPEG2)
The PC card player reads and plays the slot, make sure you put it in −Bit rate:
cards in MP3 or WMA formats. straight. If you cannot insert it, 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/
Depending on the format, the screen remove it, and insert again. 160/192/224/256/320 kbps
will indicate ‘‘MP3’’ or ‘‘WMA’’ when (MPEG1)
a card is playing. The card limit of Do not keep PC cards in the 8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/
the player is 99 folders and 999 vehicle. Direct sunlight and high 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2)
tracks. If the card has a complex heat will damage them. −Compatible with variable bit rate
structure, it takes some time for the and multi-session
system to begin playing it. To avoid damaging the card −Maximum layers
reader, do not insert hard disc (including ROOT): 8 layers
Based on PCMCIA 2.1/JEIDA 4.2, drive cards into the PC card slot.
the recommended PC cards for the
PC card reader are: You cannot close the screen
(move it to the upright position)
CompactFlash until the PC card is inserted all the
Flash ATA way into its slot or removed.
SD memory card

160
07/07/11 15:31:28 31SVA620 0166 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

The specifications for compatible Loading a PC Card Insert a PC card straight into the slot.
WMA files are: The drive will read the PC card and
−Sampling frequency: PC CARD SLOT begin to play it.
32/44.1/48 kHz
−Bit rate: Return the screen to the upright
48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps position by pressing the CLOSE
−Compatible with variable bit rate button on the edge of the screen
and multi-session panel.

Features
−Maximum layers
(including ROOT): 8 layers Push the AUDIO button beside the
screen to show the audio display and
In WMA format, DRM (digital rights operate the PC card player.
management) files cannot be played.
If the system finds a DRM file, it You can also operate the audio
skips that file and plays the next The PC card slot is behind the system without using the control
available folder or file. navigation screen. To use the PC icons on the audio screen. Press any
card player, press the OPEN button of the appropriate control buttons.
beside the screen. The screen folds The status bar appears on the
back, and the PC card slot appears. bottom of the screen. On the
navigation screen, you can see the
audio information whenever you
touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the
screen.

CONTINUED

161
07/07/11 15:31:38 31SVA620 0167 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

There are three play modes: Folder, To Select a Play Mode


Artist, and Album. Touch the PLAY
MODE icon, then choose one of the FOLDER MODE
PLAY MODE ICON
modes by touching its icon. When a
mode is selected, it is highlighted in
blue. MODE INDICATOR

Folder mode plays tracks in the


order they were added to the card.

Artist mode plays tracks in


alphabetical order, by artist and
song title.
PLAY MODE ICON PLAY MODE ICON
Album mode plays albums ARTIST MODE ALBUM MODE
(folders) in alphabetical order.

If play mode information was not


included in the tracks when they
were added to the card, it will not be
displayed on the screen.

MODE INDICATOR MODE INDICATOR

162
07/07/11 15:31:45 31SVA620 0168 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

PLAY MODE ICON

Features
To select a play mode, push the Select the desired mode by touching After you select the play mode, the
AUDIO button to show the audio the appropriate icon, or move the display changes to the selectable
display, then touch the PLAY MODE joystick, then press the ENT. playing menu. If you select
icon on the display. ‘‘Continue playing the Current Song,’’
the system goes into the selected
play mode after playing the current
file.

CONTINUED

163
07/07/11 15:31:52 31SVA620 0169 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

If you select ‘‘Play a New Track List,’’ To Change or Select Tracks/Files Icons on the screen can also be
the system goes into the selected selected with the joystick. Move the
play mode immediately and begins to PRESET BUTTON’S FUNCTION joystick left or right and up or down
play the files in order to the new list. until the icon is highlighted, then
press the ENT on the top of the
To go back to the previous screen, joystick to select the icon.
press the CANCEL button on the
right side of the screen. To exit the
play mode screens, press the AUDIO
button.

PRESET BUTTONS

You can use the preset buttons while


a card is playing to select or change
files. Each preset button’s function is
shown on the bottom of the screen.

164
07/07/11 15:31:59 31SVA620 0170 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

SKIP − Each time you press and TRACK REPEAT (FILE TRACK RANDOM (Random
release (preset 6), the player REPEAT) − To continuously replay within a folder) − This feature
skips forward to the beginning of the a file, press and release the RPT plays the files within a folder in
next file. Press and release button (preset 1). You will see random order. To activate track
(preset 5), to skip backward to TRACK REPEAT in the display. random, press and release the RDM
the beginning of the current file. Press the RPT button again to turn it button (preset 2). You will see
Press it again to skip to the off. TRACK RANDOM in the display.
beginning of the previous file. Press and hold the RDM button for 2

Features
FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM seconds to return to normal play.
FF/REW − To move rapidly within REPEAT − This feature, when
a file, press and hold (preset 4) activated, replays all the files on the FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM
or (preset 3). selected folder/artist/album in the RANDOM − This feature, when
order they are recorded or listed. To activated, plays all files in each
FOLDER SELECTION − To activate each repeat mode, press and folder/artist/album in random order,
select a different folder, press either hold the RPT button (preset 1) for 2 rather than in the order they are
side of the TUNE bar to move to the seconds. You will see FOLDER recorded or listed. To activate each
beginning of the next folder. Press REPEAT, ARTIST REPEAT or random play, press the RDM button
the ▲ side of the TUNE bar to skip ALBUM REPEAT in the display. (preset 2) 2 times. You will see
to the next folder, and the ▼ side to The system continuously replays the FOLDER RANDOM, ARTIST
move to the beginning of the current folder/artist/album. Press RANDOM or ALBUM RANDOM in
previous folder. and hold the RPT button for 2 the display.
seconds again to turn it off. Pressing
the RDM button, or selecting a
different folder/artist/album with
the TUNE bar also turns off the
repeat feature. CONTINUED

165
07/07/11 15:32:05 31SVA620 0171 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

The system then selects and plays FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM Pressing either of the SKIP buttons
files randomly. This continues until SCAN − This feature, when (preset 5 or 6), selecting a different
you deactivate each random play by activated, samples the first file in folder/artist/album with the TUNE
pressing the RDM button again, or each folder/artist/album on the PC bar, or pressing the SCAN button,
you select a different folder/artist/ card in order. To activate each scan also turns off the scan feature.
album with the TUNE bar. feature, press and hold the SCAN
button until you hear a beep. You will
SCAN − The scan function samples see FOLDER SCAN, ARTIST SCAN
all files on the PC card in the order or ALBUM SCAN in the display.
they are recorded. To activate scan,
press and release the SCAN button. The system plays the first file in the
You will see TRACK SCAN in the folder for about 10 seconds. If you do
display. You will get a 10 second nothing, the system plays the first
sampling of each file on the PC card. file in each folder, in order, for 10
Press and hold the SCAN button for seconds each. After playing the first
2 seconds to get out of scan mode file of the last folder/artist/album,
and play the last file sampled. the system returns to normal play.

Pressing either of the SKIP buttons


(preset 5 or 6) also turns off the scan
feature.

166
07/07/11 15:32:14 31SVA620 0172 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Using a Track List

FOLDER ICON ARTIST NAME

Features
TRACK LIST ICON RETURN ICON

You can also select a file directly To scroll through the display, touch In artist mode, the artist name is also
from a track list on the audio display. the ▲ or ▼ icon on the side of the displayed on the right side of each
Press the AUDIO button to show the screen. To go back to the previous selectable icon. Select the desired
audio display, then touch the Track display, touch the Return icon. file.
List icon. The track list menu
appears on the display. To play a file, touch its icon on the
screen. In folder mode, touch the
folder icon on the upper left of the
screen to move to the parent folder.
The current folder is highlighted in
blue.
CONTINUED

167
07/07/11 15:32:21 31SVA620 0173 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Song Search Function

ALBUM NAME SONG SEARCH ICON TITLE BY KEYWORD ICON

RETURN ICON
Folder mode is shown. ARTIST ICON ALBUM ICON

In album mode, the album name is When you select ‘‘Song Search’’ from You can then select any of three
also displayed on the right side of the track list display, the song search modes to search a file: Title by
each selectable icon. Select the menu appears. Keyword, Artist, and Album.
desired file.

168
07/07/11 15:32:30 31SVA620 0174 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Searching for a Song Title by Keyword To cancel the selected letter, select Searching for a Song by Artist Name
the letter and touch the Delete icon.
MORE ICON To select more characters, touch the ARTIST LIST
More icon. The other character list
will be shown.

FILE LIST

Features
DELETE ICON LIST ICON

In Title by Keyword mode, enter the Select the Artist icon, and the artist
title name, or any keyword, by list appears. Select the desired artist,
touching the letter icons on the and the artist’s file list is displayed.
screen. Press the List icon to begin
the song search. If you press the After the system searches for a song,
CANCEL button on the screen, the a file list is displayed. To scroll
display returns to the mode menu through the list, touch the ▲ or ▼
without doing a search. icon on the side of the screen. Select
the desired file by touching the
appropriate icon, or moving the
joystick and pressing the ENT.
CONTINUED

169
07/07/11 15:32:38 31SVA620 0175 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

Searching for a Song by Album Name To Stop Playing a PC card Removing a PC Card
To play the radio when a PC card is To remove a PC card from the audio
ALBUM LIST playing, press the AM/FM button or unit, fold back the screen by
touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or pressing the OPEN button (see page
XM2 icon. If a disc is in the audio 152 ). Press the eject button ( )
unit, press the CD button or touch to remove the card. If you do not
the CD icon to play the disc. Touch remove it from the slot, you cannot
the CARD icon to switch back to the return the screen to the upright
PC card player. position.

If you turn the system off while a PC To return the screen to the upright
card is playing, either with the position, press the CLOSE button.
power/volume knob or by turning
off the ignition switch, the card will You can also eject a card when the
Select the Album icon, and the stay in the drive. When you turn the ignition switch is off.
album list appears. Select the desired system back on, the card will begin
album, and its song list is displayed. playing where it left off.
You can then select the desired song
from the list. When you leave the vehicle, always
remove the PC card from the audio
unit.

170
07/07/11 15:32:43 31SVA620 0176 

Audio System (Models with navigation system)

PC Card Error Messages


If you see an error message in the Error Message Solution
display while playing a PC card, find
the solution in the chart to the right. FILE ERROR The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the disc. There
If you cannot clear the error is a possibility that the files have been damaged.
message, take your vehicle to your NO MUSIC It appears when the PC card is empty or there are no MP3 or WMA
dealer. files in the PC card. Save the MP3 or WMA files in the PC card.
MEDIA ERROR It appears when the unsupported PC card is inserted. The system

Features
supports CompactFlash card, Flash ATA card, and SanDisk memory
Card Adapter.

171
07/07/11 15:32:52 31SVA620 0177 

AM/FM Radio Reception

Radio Frequencies Radio Reception


The radio can receive the complete How well the radio receives stations
AM and FM bands. is dependent on many factors, such
Those bands cover these frequen- as the distance from the station’s
cies: transmitter, nearby large objects,
and atmospheric conditions.
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHz
FM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz A radio station’s signal gets weaker
as you get farther away from its
Radio stations on the AM band are transmitter. If you are listening to an
assigned frequencies at least 10 kHz AM station, you will notice the sound
apart (530, 540, 550). Stations on the volume becoming weaker, and the
FM band are assigned frequencies at station drifting in and out. If you are
least 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3). listening to an FM station, you will Driving very near the transmitter of
see the stereo indicator flickering off a station that is broadcasting on a
Stations must use these exact and on as the signal weakens. frequency close to the frequency of
frequencies. It is fairly common for Eventually, the stereo indicator will the station you are listening to can
stations to round-off the frequency in go off and the sound will fade also affect your radio’s reception.
their advertising, so your radio could completely as you get out of range of You may temporarily hear both
display a frequency of 100.9 even the station’s signal. stations, or hear only the station you
though the announcer may identify are close to.
the station as ‘‘FM101.’’

172
07/07/11 15:32:57 31SVA620 0178 

AM/FM Radio Reception

Electrical interference from passing


vehicles and stationary sources can
cause temporary reception problems.

As required by the FCC:


Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s

Features
authority to operate the equipment.

Radio signals, especially on the FM Radio reception can be affected by


band, are deflected by large objects atmospheric conditions such as
such as buildings and hills. Your thunderstorms, high humidity, and
radio then receives both the direct even sunspots. You may be able to
signal from the station’s transmitter, receive a distant radio station one
and the deflected signal. This causes day and not receive it the next day
the sound to distort or flutter. This is because of a change in conditions.
a main cause of poor radio reception
in city driving.

173
07/07/11 15:33:07 31SVA620 0179 

Protecting Your Discs

General Information Protecting Discs


When using CD-R or CD-RW discs, When a disc is not being played,
use only high quality discs labeled store it in its case to protect it from
for audio use. dust and other contamination. To
prevent warpage, keep discs out of
When recording a CD-R or direct sunlight and extreme heat.
CD-RW, the recording must be
closed for it to be used by the To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.
system. Wipe across the disc from the center
to the outside edge.
Play only standard round discs.
Odd-shaped discs may jam in the A new disc may be rough on the
drive or cause other problems. inner and outer edges. The small
plastic pieces causing this roughness Handle a disc by its edges; never
Handle your discs properly to can flake off and fall on the touch either surface. Do not place
prevent damage and skipping. recording surface of the disc, stabilizer rings or labels on the disc.
causing skipping or other problems. These, along with contamination
Remove these pieces by rubbing the from fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip
inner and outer edges with the side pens, can cause the disc to not play
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. of a pencil or pen. properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
The label can curl up and cause the
disc to jam in the unit. Never try to insert foreign objects in
the system or the magazine.

174
07/07/11 15:33:18 31SVA620 0180 

Protecting Your Discs

Additional Information of 1. Bubbled, wrinkled, labelled, and excessively thick discs


Recommended Discs
The in-dash disc player/changer has
a sophisticated and delicate
mechanism. If you insert a damaged
disc as indicated in this section, it
may become stuck inside and
damage the audio unit.

Features
Examples of these discs are shown Bubbled/ With Label/ Using Printer Sealed With Plastic
to the right: Wrinkled Sticker Label Kit Ring

2. Damaged discs 3. Poor quality discs

Chipped/ Warped Burrs


Cracked

CONTINUED

175
07/07/11 15:33:29 31SVA620 0181 

Protecting Your Discs

4. Small, irregular shaped discs 5. Discs with scratches, dirty discs Recommended discs are printed
with the following logo.

3-inch (8-cm) CD Triangle Shape Audio unit may not play the
Fingerprints, scratches, etc. following formats.

CD-R or CD-RW may not play due


to the recording conditions.

Scratches and fingerprints on the


discs may cause the sound to skip.

This audio unit cannot play a Dual-


disc .
Can Shape Arrow Shape

176
07/07/11 15:33:38 31SVA620 0182 

Remote Audio Controls

CH BUTTON MODE BUTTON The VOL button adjusts the volume beep. The system searches up or
up (▲) or down (▼). Press the top down from the current frequency to
or bottom of the button, hold it until find a station with a strong signal.
the desired volume is reached, then
release it. If you are playing a disc, the system
skips to the beginning of the next
The MODE button changes the track (file in MP3 or WMA format)
mode. Pressing the button each time you press the top (+) of

Features
repeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM, the CH button. Press the bottom
disc (if a disc is loaded), or a PC card (−) to return to the beginning of the
(if it is loaded). On models with current track or file. Press it twice to
VOL BUTTON satellite radio system, you can also return to the previous track or file.
select XM radio.
If equipped You will see the track/file number
Three controls for the audio system If you are listening to the radio, use and the elapsed time. If the disc has
are mounted in the steering wheel the CH button to change stations. text data or is compressed in MP3 or
hub. These let you control basic Each time you press and release the WMA, you can also see any other
functions without removing your top (+) of the button, the system information (track title, file name,
hand from the wheel. goes to the next preset station on the folder name, etc.).
band you are listening to. Press and
release the bottom (−) to go back to
the previous station.

To activate the seek function, press


and hold the top (+) or bottom (−)
of the CH button until you hear a CONTINUED

177
07/07/11 15:33:44 31SVA620 0183 

Remote Audio Controls, Auxiliary Input Jack

If you are playing a PC card, press Auxiliary Input Jack


the top (+) of the CH button to
advance to the next file. Press the
bottom (−) to go back to the
previous file.

In MP3 or WMA mode, you can use


the seek function to select folders.
Press and hold the top (+) of the
CH button until you hear a beep, to
skip forward to the first file of the
next folder. Press the bottom (−) to
skip backward to the previous folder. AUXILIARY INPUT JACK

If equipped
The auxiliary input jack is
underneath the accessory power
socket on the front panel. The
system will accept auxiliary input
from standard audio accessories.

When a compatible audio unit is


connected to the jack, press the AUX
or CD/AUX button to select it.

178
07/07/11 15:33:51 31SVA620 0184 

Radio Theft Protection

On models with audio system If your vehicle’s battery is The system will retain your AM and
Your vehicle’s audio system will disconnected or goes dead, or the FM presets even if power is
disable itself if it is disconnected radio fuse is removed, the audio disconnected.
from electrical power for any reason. system will disable itself. If this
To make it work again, you must happens, you will see ‘‘ENTER
enter a specific digit code using the CODE’’ in the frequency display the
preset buttons (icon on vehicle’s with next time you turn on the system.
navigation system). Because there Use the preset buttons (icons on

Features
are hundreds of number vehicles with navigation system) to
combinations possible from specific enter the code. The code is on the
digits, making the system work radio code card included in your
without knowing the exact code is owner’s manual kit. When it is
nearly impossible. entered correctly, the radio will start
playing.
You should have received a card that
lists your audio system’s code and If you make a mistake entering the
serial numbers. It is best to store this code, do not start over; complete the
card in a safe place at home. In sequence, then enter the correct
addition, you should write the audio code. You have 10 tries to enter the
system’s serial number in this owner’s correct code. If you are unsuccessful
manual. in 10 attempts, you must then leave
the system on for 1 hour before
If you lose the card, you must obtain trying again.
the code number from a dealer. To
do this, you will need the system’s
serial number.

179
07/07/11 15:34:00 31SVA620 0185 

Setting the Clock

On models without navigation system U.S. LX, and Canadian DX, DX-G EX, EX-L and Si models
To set the time, press the CLOCK and LX models
(AM, AM/FM) button until the CLOCK BUTTON CLOCK BUTTON
displayed time begins to blink, then
release the button.

Change the hours by pressing the H


(preset 1) button until the numbers
advance to the desired time. Change
the minutes by pressing the M
(preset 2) button until the numbers
advance to the desired time.

Press the CLOCK (AM, AM/FM)


button again to enter the set time.
H (HOUR) R (RESET) H (HOUR) R (RESET)
BUTTON BUTTON BUTTON BUTTON
You can quickly set the time to the M (MINUTE) M (MINUTE)
nearest hour. If the displayed time is BUTTON BUTTON
before the half hour, pressing the
CLOCK (AM, AM/FM) button until For example: 1:06 will reset to 1:00 time is updated automatically by the
you hear a beep, then pressing the R 1:52 will reset to 2:00 GPS. Refer to the navigation system
(preset 3) button sets the clock back manual for how to adjust the time.
to the previous hour. If the displayed On models with navigation system
time is after the half hour, the clock The navigation system receives
sets forward to the beginning of the signals from the global positioning
next hour. system (GPS), and the displayed

180
07/07/11 15:34:07 31SVA620 0186 

Security System

If equipped The alarm will sound if the trunk


The security system helps to protect Except Si Si lock is forced, or the trunk is opened
your vehicle and valuables from theft. with the trunk release handle or the
The horn sounds and a combination emergency trunk opener.
of headlights, parking lights, side
marker lights, and taillights flashes if The security system will not set if
someone attempts to break into your the hood, trunk, or either door is not
vehicle or remove the radio. This fully closed. If the system will not set,

Features
alarm continues for 2 minutes, then check the door and trunk open
the system resets. To reset an indicators on the instrument panel
alarming system before the 2 SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (see page 64 ), to see if the doors
minutes have elapsed, unlock the and the trunk are fully closed. Since
driver’s door with the key or the it is not part of the monitor display,
remote transmitter. Once the security system is set, manually check the hood.
opening either door without using
The security system automatically the key or the remote transmitter, NOTE: Use the remote transmitter
sets 15 seconds after you lock the the hood, or the trunk will cause the to quickly check that the hood, the
doors, hood, and trunk. For the system to alarm. It also alarms if the trunk, and both doors are closed.
system to activate, you must lock the audio unit is removed from the Push the lock button twice within 5
doors from the outside with the key, dashboard or the wiring is cut. seconds. There should be an audible
lock tab, door lock switch, or remote confirmation beep.
transmitter. The security system With the system set, you can still
indicator on the instrument panel open the trunk with the master key Do not attempt to alter this system
starts blinking immediately to show (U.S. LX model) or the remote or add other devices to it.
you the system is setting itself. transmitter (U.S. EX, EX-L and Si
models) without triggering the alarm.

181
07/10/30 14:05:47 31SVA620 0187 

Cruise Control

If equipped Using Cruise Control 3. Press and release the SET/


Cruise control allows you to maintain DECEL button on the steering
a set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h) CRUISE BUTTON RES/ACCEL wheel. The CRUISE CONTROL
without keeping your foot on the indicator on the instrument panel
accelerator pedal. It should be used comes on to show the system is
for cruising on straight, open now activated.
highways. It is not recommended for
city driving, winding roads, slippery Cruise control may not hold the set
roads, heavy rain, or bad weather. speed when you are going up and
down hills. If your vehicle speed
increases going down a hill, use the
brakes to slow down. This will cancel
Improper use of the cruise SET/DECEL CANCEL BUTTON the cruise control. To resume the set
control can lead to a crash. speed, press the RES/ACCEL button.
1. Push the CRUISE button on the The CRUISE CONTROL indicator
Use the cruise control only steering wheel. The CRUISE on the instrument panel will come
when traveling on open MAIN indicator on the instrument back on.
highways in good weather. panel comes on.
When climbing a steep hill, the
The cruise control system can be automatic transmission may
left on, even when it is not in use. downshift to hold the set speed.

2. Accelerate to the desired cruising


speed above 25 mph (40 km/h).

182
07/07/11 15:34:25 31SVA620 0188 

Cruise Control

Changing the Set Speed You can decrease the set cruising Even with the cruise control turned
You can increase the set cruising speed in any of these ways: on, you can still use the accelerator
speed in any of these ways: pedal to speed up for passing. After
Press and hold the SET/DECEL completing the pass, take your foot
Press and hold the RES/ACCEL button. Release the button when off the accelerator pedal. The vehicle
button. When you reach the you reach the desired speed. will return to the set cruising speed.
desired cruising speed, release the
button. To slow down in very small Resting your foot on the brake or

Features
amounts, tap the SET/DECEL clutch pedal causes the cruise
Push on the accelerator pedal until button. Each time you do this, control to cancel.
you reach the desired cruising your vehicle will slow down about
speed, then press the SET/ 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
DECEL button.
Tap the brake or clutch pedal
To increase the speed in very lightly with your foot. The
small amounts, tap the RES/ CRUISE CONTROL indicator on
ACCEL button. Each time you do the instrument panel goes out.
this, your vehicle speeds up about When the vehicle slows to the
1 mph (1.6 km/h). desired speed, press the SET/
DECEL button.

183
07/07/11 15:34:32 31SVA620 0189 

Cruise Control

Cancelling Cruise Control Resuming the Set Speed


You can cancel cruise control in any When you push the CANCEL button,
of these ways: or tap the brake or clutch pedal, the
system remembers the previously
Tap the brake or clutch pedal. set cruising speed. To return to that
speed, accelerate to above 25 mph
Push the CANCEL button on the (40 km/h) and then press and
steering wheel. release the RES/ACCEL button. The
CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes
Push the CRUISE button on the on, and the vehicle accelerates to the
steering wheel. same cruising speed as before.

Pressing the CRUISE button turns


the system off and erases the
previous cruising speed.

184
07/07/11 15:34:36 31SVA620 0190 

Before Driving

Before you begin driving your Break-in Period .............................. 186


vehicle, you should know what Fuel Recommendation .................. 186
gasoline to use and how to check the Service Station Procedures .......... 187
levels of important fluids. You also Refueling..................................... 187
need to know how to properly store Opening and Closing
luggage or packages. The the Hood ................................. 188
information in this section will help Oil Check .................................... 189
you. If you plan to add any Engine Coolant Check .............. 191
accessories to your vehicle, please Fuel Economy ................................ 192
read the information in this section Accessories and Modifications .... 195

Before Driving
first. Carrying Cargo .............................. 197

185
07/07/11 15:34:45 31SVA620 0191 

Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation

Break-in Period Fuel Recommendation We recommend using quality


Help assure your vehicle’s future All models except Si gasolines containing detergent
reliability and performance by paying Your vehicle is designed to operate additives that help prevent fuel
extra attention to how you drive on unleaded gasoline with a pump system and engine deposits.
during the first 600 miles (1,000 km). octane number of 87 or higher. Use
During this period: of a lower octane gasoline can cause In addition, in order to maintain good
a persistent, heavy, metallic rapping performance, fuel economy, and
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapid noise that can lead to engine damage. emissions control, we strongly
acceleration. recommend, in areas where it is
Si model only available, the use of gasoline that
Do not change the oil until the Your vehicle is designed to operate does NOT contain manganese-based
scheduled maintenance time. on premium unleaded gasoline with a fuel additives such as MMT.
pump octane number of 91 or higher.
Avoid hard braking for the first Use of a lower octane gasoline can Use of gasoline with these additives
200 miles (300 km). cause occasional metallic knocking may adversely affect performance,
noises in the engine and will result in and cause the malfunction indicator
You should also follow these decreased engine performance. Use lamp on your instrument panel to
recommendations with an of a gasoline with a pump octane come on. If this happens, contact
overhauled or exchanged engine, or number less than 87 can lead to your authorized dealer for service.
when the brakes are replaced. engine damage.

186
07/07/11 15:34:54 31SVA620 0192 

Service Station Procedures

Some gasoline today is blended with Refueling


oxygenates such as ethanol or
MTBE. Your vehicle is designed to Push Gasoline is highly flammable
operate on oxygenated gasoline and explosive. You can be
containing up to 10% ethanol by burned or seriously injured
volume and up to 15% MTBE by when handling fuel.
volume. Do not use gasoline
containing methanol. Stop the engine, and keep
heat, sparks, and flame away.
If you notice any undesirable Handle fuel only outdoors.

Before Driving
operating symptoms, try another Wipe up spills immediately.
service station or switch to another
brand of gasoline.
TETHER
For further important fuel-related 1. Park with the driver’s side closest
information, please refer to your to the service station pump.
Quick Start Guide.
2. Open the fuel fill door by pushing
On Si model on the handle to the left of the
You may hear a knocking noise from driver’s seat.
the engine if you drive the vehicle at
low engine speed (below about 1,000 HOLDER
rpm) in a higher gear. To stop this,
raise the engine speed by shifting to FUEL FILL CAP
a lower gear.
CONTINUED

187
07/07/11 15:35:02 31SVA620 0193 

Service Station Procedures

3. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. 5. Screw the fuel fill cap back on Opening and Closing the Hood
You may hear a hissing sound as until it clicks at least once. If you
pressure inside the tank escapes. do not properly tighten the cap, HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
The fuel fill cap is attached to the the malfunction indicator lamp
fuel filler with a tether. Place the may come on (see page 282 ). You
cap in the holder on the fuel fill will also see a ‘‘CHECK FUEL
door. CAP’’ message on the information
display.
4. Stop filling the tank after the fuel
nozzle automatically clicks off. Do 6. Push the fuel fill door closed until
not try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Leave it latches.
some room for the fuel to expand
with temperature changes.

If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off 1. Park the vehicle, and set the
even though the tank is not full, parking brake. Pull the hood
there may be a problem with your release handle under the lower left
vehicle’s fuel vapor recovery corner of the dashboard. The
system. The system helps keep hood will pop up slightly.
fuel vapor from going into the
atmosphere. Try filling at another
pump. If this does not fix the
problem, consult your dealer.

188
07/07/11 15:35:13 31SVA620 0194 

Service Station Procedures

Oil Check
GRIP DIPSTICK

Before Driving
LATCH
SUPPORT ROD CLIP DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L

2. Put your fingers under the front 3. Holding the grip, pull the support Wait a few minutes after turning the
edge of the hood near the center. rod out of its clip. Insert the end engine off before you check the oil.
Slide your hand to the left until into the designated hole pointed
you feel the hood latch handle. by an arrow in the hood. 1. Remove the dipstick (orange
Push this handle up to release it. handle).
Lift up the hood. To close the hood, lift it up slightly
to remove the support rod from 2. Wipe off the dipstick with a clean
If the hood latch handle moves the hole. Put the support rod back cloth or paper towel.
stiffly, or if you can open the hood into its holding clip. Lower the
without lifting the handle, the hood to about a foot (30 cm) above 3. Insert the dipstick all the way back
mechanism should be cleaned and the fender, then let it drop. Make into its hole.
lubricated. sure it is securely latched. CONTINUED

189
07/07/11 15:35:19 31SVA620 0195 

Service Station Procedures

DIPSTICK DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si

UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARK
Si LOWER MARK

4. Remove the dipstick again, and If it is near or below the lower mark,
check the level. It should be see Adding Engine Oil on page 234 .
between the upper and lower
marks.

190
07/07/11 15:35:25 31SVA620 0196 

Service Station Procedures

Engine Coolant Check


MAX RESERVE TANK MAX RESERVE TANK

Before Driving
MIN
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si MIN

Look at the coolant level in the Refer to Owner’s Maintenance


radiator reserve tank. Make sure it is Checks on page 230 for information
between the MAX and MIN lines. If about checking other items on your
it is below the MIN line, see Adding vehicle.
Engine Coolant on page 238 for
information on adding the proper
coolant.

191
07/07/11 15:35:34 31SVA620 0197 

Fuel Economy

Actual Mileage and EPA Fuel


Economy Estimates Comparison. City MPG Highway MPG
Fuel economy is not a fixed number.
It varies based on driving conditions,
driving habits and vehicle condition.
Therefore, it is not possible for one
set of estimates to predict fuel
economy precisely for all drivers in
all environments. Combined Fuel Estimated Annual
Economy Fuel Cost
The EPA fuel economy estimates
shown in the example to the right (Sample U.S. EPA label shown)
are a useful tool for comparison
when buying a vehicle. EPA achieved is also provided. Estimated Annual Fuel Cost −
estimates include: Provides an estimated annual fuel
Combined Fuel Economy − cost, based on 15,000 miles (20,000
City MPG − Represents urban Represents a combination of city and km) per year multiplied by the cost
driving in a vehicle in light traffic. A highway driving. The scale per gallon (based on EPA fuel cost
range of miles per gallon achieved is represents the range of combined data) divided by the combined fuel
also provided. fuel economy for other vehicles in economy.
the class.
Highway MPG − Represents a For more information on fuel
mixture of rural and interstate economy ratings and factors that
driving, in a warmed-up vehicle, affect fuel economy, visit www.
typical of longer trips in free-flowing fueleconomy.gov (Canada: Visit www.
traffic. A range of miles per gallon vehicles.gc.ca)

192
07/07/11 15:35:47 31SVA620 0198 

Fuel Economy

Fuel Economy Factors Use the recommended viscosity Drive Efficiently


The following factors can lower your motor oil, displaying the API Drive moderately − Rapid
vehicle’s fuel economy: Certification Seal (see page acceleration, abrupt cornering,
Aggressive driving (hard 234). and hard braking increase fuel
acceleration and braking) consumption.
Excessive idling, accelerating and Maintain proper tire inflation
braking in stop-and-go traffic − An under-inflated tire increases Observe the speed limit −
Cold engine operation (engines ‘‘rolling resistance,’’ which reduces Aerodynamic drag has a big effect
are more efficient when warmed fuel economy. on fuel mileage at speeds above 45
up) mph (75 km/h). Reduce your

Before Driving
Driving with a heavy load or the Avoid carrying excess weight in speed and you reduce the drag.
air conditioner running your vehicle − It puts a heavier Trailers, car top carriers, roof
Improperly inflated tires load on the engine, increasing fuel racks and bike racks are also big
consumption. contributors to increased drag.
Improving Fuel Economy
Keep your vehicle clean − In Always drive in the highest gear
Vehicle Maintenance particular, a build-up of snow or possible − If your vehicle has a
A properly maintained vehicle mud on your vehicle’s underside manual transmission, you can
maximizes fuel economy. Poor adds weight and rolling resistance. boost your fuel economy by up
maintenance can significantly reduce Frequent cleaning helps your fuel shifting as early as possible.
fuel economy. Always maintain your economy.
vehicle according to the maintenance Avoid excessive idling − Idling
messages displayed on the results in 0 miles per gallon.
information display (see Owner’s
Maintenance Checks on page 230 ).
For example: CONTINUED

193
07/07/11 15:35:57 31SVA620 0199 

Fuel Economy

Minimize the use of the air Checking Your Fuel Economy


conditioning system − The A/C
puts an extra load on the engine
which makes it use more fuel. Use
the fresh-air ventilation when
possible. Gallons of Miles per
Miles driven fuel Gallon
Plan and combine trips −
Combine several short trips into
one. A warmed-up engine is more
fuel efficient than a cold one. 100 Liter Kilometers L per 100 km

Calculating Fuel Economy

Measuring Techniques
Direct calculation is the
recommended source of information 1) Fill the fuel tank until the nozzle automatically clicks off.
about your actual fuel economy. 2) Reset trip counter to zero.
Using frequency of fill-ups or taking 3) Record the total gallons (liters) needed to refill.
fuel gauge readings are NOT 4) Follow one of the simple calculations above.
accurate measures of fuel economy.
Fuel economy may improve over the
first several thousand miles.

194
07/07/11 15:36:06 31SVA620 0200 

Accessories and Modifications

Modifying your vehicle, or installing Before installing any accessory:


some non-Honda accessories, can
make your vehicle unsafe. Before Improper accessories or Make sure the accessory does not
you make any modifications or add modifications can affect your obscure any lights, or interfere
any accessories, be sure to read the vehicle’s handling, stability, and with proper vehicle operation or
following information. performance, and cause a performance.
crash in which you can be hurt
Accessories or killed. Be sure electronic accessories do
Your dealer has Honda accessories not overload electrical circuits
that allow you to personalize your Follow all instructions in this (see page 284 ) or interfere with
vehicle, or improve its performance. owner’s manual regarding the proper operation of your
These accessories have been accessories and modifications. vehicle.
designed and approved for your
vehicle, and are covered by warranty. Before installing any electronic
When properly installed, cellular accessory, have the installer
Although non-Honda accessories phones, alarms, two-way radios, and contact your dealer for assistance.
may fit on your vehicle, they may not low-powered audio systems should If possible, have your dealer
meet factory specifications, and not interfere with your vehicle’s inspect the final installation.
could adversely affect your vehicle’s computer controlled systems, such
handling and stability. as your airbags, anti-lock brakes, and Do not install accessories on the
tire pressure monitoring system (if side pillars or across the rear
equipped). windows. Accessories installed in
these areas may interfere with
proper operation of the side
curtain airbags.

195
07/07/11 15:36:13 31SVA620 0201 

Accessories and Modifications

Modifying Your Vehicle Non-Honda wheels, because they


Removing parts from your vehicle, are a universal design, can cause
or replacing components with excessive stress on suspension
non-Honda components could components and will not be
seriously affect your vehicle’s compatible with the tire pressure
handling, stability, and reliability. monitoring system (TPMS)*.

Some examples are: * : If equipped

Lowering the vehicle with a non- Larger or smaller wheels and tires
Honda suspension kit that can interfere with the operation of
significantly reduces ground your vehicle’s anti-lock brakes and
clearance can allow the other systems.
undercarriage to hit speed bumps
or other raised objects, which Modifying your steering wheel or
could cause the airbags to deploy. any other part of your vehicle’s
safety features can make the
Raising your vehicle with a systems ineffective.
non-Honda suspension kit can
affect the handling and stability. If you plan to modify your vehicle,
consult your dealer.

196
07/07/11 15:36:21 31SVA620 0202 

Carrying Cargo

Your vehicle has several convenient


storage areas:
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT* DOOR POCKET
Glove box
Door and seat-back pockets
CENTER POCKET Console compartment
Center pocket
Trunk, including the rear seats
when folded down

Before Driving
However, carrying too much cargo,
or improperly storing it, can affect
your vehicle’s handling, stability,
stopping distance, and tires, and
make it unsafe. Before carrying any
type of cargo, be sure to read the
following pages.

SEAT-BACK POCKET* GLOVE BOX


TRUNK

*: If equipped

197
07/07/11 15:36:33 31SVA620 0203 

Carrying Cargo

Load Limits (4)The resulting figure equals the


The maximum load for your vehicle available amount of cargo and
is 850 lbs (385 kg) for U.S. models Overloading or improper luggage load capacity. For
and 395 kg for Canadian models. loading can affect handling and example, if the ‘‘XXX’’ amount
stability and cause a crash in equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be
See Tire And Loading Information which you can be hurt or killed. five 150 lb. passengers in your
label attached to the driver’s vehicle, the amount of available
doorjamb. Follow all load limits and other cargo and luggage load capacity is
loading guidelines in this 650 lbs.
Label Example manual. (1,400 − 750 (5 × 150) = 650 lbs.)

Steps for Determining Correct Load (5)Determine the combined weight


Limit − of luggage and cargo being loaded
(1)Locate the statement ‘‘The on the vehicle. That weight may
combined weight of occupants and not safely exceed the available
cargo should never exceed XXX cargo and luggage load capacity
kg or XXX lbs.’’ on your vehicle’s calculated in Step 4.
placard.
This figure includes the total weight (6)If your vehicle will be towing a
of all occupants, cargo, and (2)Determine the combined weight trailer, load from your trailer will
accessories, and the tongue load if of the driver and passengers that be transferred to your vehicle.
you are towing a trailer. will be riding in your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine
how this reduces the available
(3)Subtract the combined weight of cargo and luggage load capacity of
the driver and passengers from your vehicle.
XXX kg or XXX lbs.

198
07/07/11 15:36:39 31SVA620 0204 

Carrying Cargo

In addition, the total weight of the


vehicle, all occupants, accessories,
cargo, and trailer tongue load must
Example 1 not exceed the Gross Vehicle
Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross
(150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs) (550 lbs) Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). Both
are on a label on the driver’s
doorjamb.

Example 2

Before Driving
Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight
(150 lbs x 4 = 600 lbs) (250 lbs)

Example 3
Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight
(150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs) (100 lbs)

199
07/07/11 15:36:48 31SVA620 0205 

Carrying Cargo

Carrying Items in the Passenger Keep the glove box closed while Cargo Net
Compartment driving. If it is open, a passenger Optional
Store or secure all items that could could injure their knees during a The cargo net can be used to help
be thrown around and hurt crash or sudden stop. hold down items stored in the trunk.
someone during a crash.
Carrying Cargo in the Trunk
Do not put any items on top of the Distribute cargo evenly on the
rear shelf. They can block your floor of the trunk, placing the
view and be thrown around the heaviest items on the bottom and
vehicle during a crash. as far forward as possible.

Be sure items placed on the floor If you fold down the back seat, tie
behind the front seats cannot roll down items that could be thrown
under the seats and interfere with about the vehicle during a crash or
the driver’s ability to operate the sudden stop.
pedals, the proper operation of the
seats, or the proper operation of If you carry large items that
the sensors under the seats. prevent you from closing the trunk
lid, exhaust gas can enter the
Also, keep all cargo below the passenger area. To avoid the
bottom of the windows. If it is possibility of carbon monoxide
higher, it could interfere with the poisoning, follow the instructions
proper operation of the side on page 50 .
curtain airbags.

200
07/07/11 15:36:52 31SVA620 0206 

Driving

This section gives you tips on Driving Guidelines ........................ 202


starting the engine under various Preparing to Drive ......................... 203
conditions, and how to operate the Starting the Engine........................ 204
manual and automatic transmissions. Manual Transmission.................... 205
It also includes important Automatic Transmission............... 208
information on parking your vehicle, Parking ............................................ 212
the braking system, the vehicle Braking System.............................. 213
stability assist (VSA) system, and Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) ................ 214
the tire pressure monitoring system Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
(TPMS). System......................................... 216
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) ....................................... 218

Driving
Towing a Trailer ............................ 221

201
07/07/11 15:36:57 31SVA620 0207 

Driving Guidelines

Si model Because of the low-profile tires


Your vehicle is designed to give you fitted to your vehicle, the alloy
optimum handling and performance wheels are closer to the ground.
on well-maintained roads. As part of Driving over a pothole or road
this design, your vehicle has a debris at too high a speed can
minimum of ground clearance and seriously damage a wheel. Slow
very low-profile tires. down under these conditions.

Use caution if you ever drive your


vehicle on very rough or rutted
roads. You could damage the
suspension and underbody by
bottoming out. Going too fast over
parking lot ‘‘speed bumps’’ can Curbs and steep inclines could
also cause damage. damage the front and rear
bumpers. Low curbs that do not
affect the average vehicle may be
high enough to hit the bumper on
your vehicle. The front or rear
bumper may scrape when trying to
drive onto an incline, such as a
steep driveway or trailer ramps.

202
07/07/11 15:37:07 31SVA620 0208 

Preparing to Drive

You should do the following checks 5. Check that any items you may be 10.Fasten your seat belt. Check that
and adjustments before you drive carrying are stored properly or your passengers have fastened
your vehicle. fastened down securely. their seat belts (see page 14 ).

1. Make sure all windows, mirrors, 6. Check the seat adjustment (see 11.When you start the engine, check
and outside lights are clean and page 92 ). the gauges and indicators in the
unobstructed. Remove frost, snow, instrument panel (see page 55 ).
or ice. 7. Check the adjustment of the
inside and outside mirrors (see
2. Check that the hood is fully closed. page 104 ).

3. Check that the trunk is fully 8. Check the steering wheel

Driving
closed. adjustment (see page 75 ).

4. Visually check the tires. If a tire 9. Make sure the doors are securely
looks low, use a gauge to check its closed and locked.
pressure.

203
07/07/11 15:37:15 31SVA620 0209 

Starting the Engine

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. In cold weather, turn off all The immobilizer system protects your The engine is harder to start in cold
electrical accessories to reduce vehicle f rom thef t. If an improperly- weather. Also, the thinner air f ound at
the drain on the battery. coded key (or other device) is used, the altitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400
engine’s f uel system is disabled. For meters) adds to this problem.
3. Manual transmission: more inf ormation, see page 77 .
Press the clutch pedal down all the
way. The START (III) position 5. If the engine does not start within
does not function unless the clutch 15 seconds, or starts but stalls
pedal is pressed. right away, repeat step 4 with the
accelerator pedal pressed halfway
Automatic transmission: down. If the engine starts, release
Make sure the shift lever is in pressure on the accelerator pedal
Park. Press on the brake pedal. so the engine does not race.

4. Without touching the accelerator 6. If the engine fails to start, press


pedal, turn the ignition key to the the accelerator pedal all the way
START (III) position. Do not hold down, and hold it there while
the key in the START (III) starting to clear flooding. If the
position for more than 15 seconds engine still does not start, return
at a time. If the engine does not to step 5.
start right away, pause for at least
10 seconds before trying again.

204
07/07/11 15:37:23 31SVA620 0210 

Manual Transmission

cause your clutch to wear out faster.

Come to a full stop before you shift


into reverse. You can damage the
transmission by trying to shift into
reverse with the vehicle moving.
Push down the clutch pedal, and
pause for a few seconds before
shifting into reverse, or shift into one
of the forward gears for a moment.
This stops the gears so they won’t
‘‘grind.’’

Driving
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si

The manual transmission is On vehicles with 6-speed manual On Si model


synchronized in all forward gears for transmission, the lockout system Note: The engine can be damaged if
smooth operation. It has a lockout so prevents you from shifting directly you inadvertently downshift into the
you cannot shift directly from fifth to from any forward gear to reverse wrong gear (for example, going from
reverse. while the vehicle is moving at a third gear at high rpms to second gear
certain speed (see page 207 ). instead of upshifting to fourth gear; the
engine speed limiter will not work in this
When shifting up or down, make situation).
sure you push the clutch pedal down
all the way, shift to the next gear,
and let the pedal up gradually. When
you are not shifting, do not rest your
foot on the clutch pedal. This can CONTINUED

205
07/07/11 15:37:30 31SVA620 0211 

Manual Transmission

When slowing down, you can get time on a hot day, be careful before On models with 6-speed manual
extra braking from the engine by moving the shift lever. Because of transmission
shifting to a lower gear. This extra the heat, the shift lever may be
braking can help you maintain a safe extremely hot. If the outside Shift up Normal acceleration
speed and prevent your brakes from temperature is low, the shift lever
overheating while going down a feels cold. 1st to 2nd 17 mph (27 km/h)
steep hill. Before downshifting, 2nd to 3rd 29 mph (47 km/h)
make sure the engine speed will not Recommended Shift Points 3rd to 4th 37 mph (60 km/h)
go into the tachometer’s red zone in Drive in the highest gear that lets 4th to 5th 43 mph (69 km/h)
the lower gear. the engine run and accelerate 5th to 6th 49 mph (79 km/h)
smoothly. This will give you good
fuel economy and effective
emissions control. The following
Rapid slowing or speeding up shift points are recommended:
can cause loss of control on
slippery surfaces. If you crash, On models with 5-speed manual
you can be injured. transmission

Use extra care when driving on Shift up Normal acceleration


slippery surfaces.
1st to 2nd 15 mph (24 km/h)
2nd to 3rd 27 mph (43 km/h)
On Si model 3rd to 4th 39 mph (63 km/h)
Your vehicle is equipped with an 4th to 5th 53 mph (85 km/h)
aluminum shift lever. If you leave the
vehicle parked outside for a long

206
07/07/11 15:37:40 31SVA620 0212 

Manual Transmission

Engine Speed Limiter Reverse Lockout 2. If you are still unable to shift to
If you exceed the maximum speed 6-speed manual transmission reverse, apply the parking brake,
for the gear you are in, the engine The manual transmission has and turn the ignition key to the
speed will enter into the tachometer’s lockout so you cannot accidentally ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)
red zone. If this occurs, you may feel shift from any forward gear to position.
the engine cut in and out. This is reverse while the vehicle is moving
caused by a limiter in the engine’s at a certain speed. If you cannot shift 3. Press the clutch pedal, and shift to
computer controls. The engine will to reverse when the vehicle is reverse.
run normally when you reduce the stopped, do the following.
rpm below the red zone. 4. With the clutch pedal still pressed,
start the engine.
Before downshifting, make sure the

Driving
engine will not go into the If you need to use this procedure to
tachometer’s red zone. shift to reverse, your vehicle may be
developing a problem. Have the
On Si model vehicle checked by your dealer.
Your vehicle has a rev limit indicator
to show you when the engine speed
is near the tachometer’s red zone
(see page 61 ).
Move the shift lever in sequence.

1. With the clutch pedal pressed,


move the shift lever to the first/
second gear side of the neutral
gate, then shift to reverse.

207
07/07/11 15:37:47 31SVA620 0213 

Automatic Transmission

Shift Lever Position Indicators The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for a Shifting
few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position. If it flashes while driving (in
any shift position), it indicates a
possible problem in the transmission. SHIFT LEVER

If the malfunction indicator lamp


comes on along with the ‘‘D’’
indicator, there is a problem with the
automatic transmission control
system. Avoid rapid acceleration, and RELEASE
have the transmission checked by BUTTON
your dealer as soon as possible.
These indicators on the instrument To shift from Park to any position,
panel show which position the shift press firmly on the brake pedal, and
lever is in. press the release button on the front
of the shift lever, then move the
lever. You cannot shift out of Park
when the ignition switch is in the
LOCK (0) or ACCESSORY (I)
position.

208
07/07/11 15:37:55 31SVA620 0214 

Automatic Transmission

To shift from: Do this: If you have done all of the above and Neutral (N) − Use neutral if you
P to R Press the brake pedal, and still cannot move the lever out of need to restart a stalled engine, or if
press the shift lever release Park, see Shift Lock Release on it is necessary to stop briefly with
button. page 211 . the engine idling. Shift to the Park
R to P position if you need to leave your
N to R Press the shift lever release To avoid transmission damage, come vehicle for any reason. Press on the
D3 to 2 button. to a complete stop before shifting brake pedal when you are moving
2 to 1 into Park. You must also press the the shift lever from neutral to
1 to 2 release button to shift into Park. The another gear.
2 to D3 shift lever must be in Park before
D3 to D you can remove the key from the Drive (D) − Use this position for
D to N Move the shift lever. ignition switch. your normal driving. The

Driving
D to D3 transmission automatically selects a
N to D Reverse (R) − Press the brake suitable gear (1 through 5) for your
R to N pedal and press the release button speed and acceleration. You may
on the front of the shift lever to shift notice the transmission shifting up at
Park (P) − This position mechani- from Park to reverse. To shift from higher engine speeds when the
cally locks the transmission. Use reverse to neutral, come to a engine is cold. This helps the engine
Park whenever you are turning off or complete stop, and then shift. Press warm up faster.
starting the engine. To shift out of the release button before shifting
Park, you must press on the brake into reverse from neutral.
pedal and have your foot off the
accelerator pedal. Press the release
button on the front of the shift lever
to move it.
CONTINUED

209
07/07/11 15:38:03 31SVA620 0215 

Automatic Transmission

Drive (D3) −This position is similar First (1) − To shift from second to Engine Speed Limiter
to D, except only the first three first, press the release button on the If you exceed the maximum speed
gears are selected. Use D3 to provide front of the shift lever. This position for the gear you are in, the engine
engine braking when going down a locks the transmission in first gear. speed will enter into the tachometer’s
steep hill. D3 can also keep the By upshifting and downshifting red zone. If this occurs, you may feel
transmission from cycling between through 1, 2, D3, and D, you can the engine cut in and out. This is
third and fourth gears in stop-and-go operate the transmission much like a caused by a limiter in the engine’s
driving. manual transmission without a computer controls. The engine will
clutch pedal. run normally when you reduce the
Second (2) − To shift to second, rpm below the red zone.
press the release button on the front
of the shift lever. This position locks
the transmission in second gear. It
does not downshift to first gear
when you come to a stop.

Use second gear:


For more power when climbing.
To increase engine braking when
going down steep hills.
For starting out on a slippery
surface or in deep snow.
To help reduce wheel spin.

210
07/07/11 15:38:12 31SVA620 0216 

Automatic Transmission

Shift Lock Release metal fingernail file, carefully pry 6. Remove the key from the shift
Do this if pushing on the brake pedal on the edge of the cover to remove lock release slot, then install the
and pressing the release button does it. cover. Make sure the notch on the
not shift the transmission out of cover is on the rear.
Park: RELEASE BUTTON Return the key to the ignition
switch, press the brake pedal, and
1. Set the parking brake. restart the engine.

2. Remove the key from the ignition If you need to use the shift lock
switch. release, it means your vehicle is
developing a problem. Have it
COVER checked by your dealer.

Driving
SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT

4. Insert the key in the shift lock


release slot.

5. Push down on the key while you


press the release button on the
front of the shift lever and move
the shift lever out of Park to
3. Put a cloth on the edge of the shift neutral.
lock release slot cover. Using a
small flat-tipped screwdriver or a

211
07/07/11 15:38:22 31SVA620 0217 

Parking

Always use the parking brake when Parking Tips If the vehicle is facing uphill, turn
you park your vehicle. Make sure Make sure the moonroof (if the front wheels away from the
the parking brake is set firmly, or equipped) and the windows are curb. If your vehicle has a manual
your vehicle may roll if it is parked closed. transmission, put it in first gear.
on an incline.
Turn off the lights. If the vehicle is facing downhill,
If your vehicle has an automatic turn the front wheels toward the
transmission, set the parking brake Place any packages, valuables, etc., curb. If your vehicle has a manual
before you put the transmission in in the trunk or take them with you. transmission, put it in reverse gear.
Park. This keeps the vehicle from
moving and putting pressure on the Lock the doors. Make sure the parking brake is
parking mechanism in the fully released before driving away.
transmission. On vehicles with security system Driving with the parking brake
Check the indicator on the partially set can overheat or
instrument panel to verify that the damage the rear brakes.
security system is set.

Never park over dry leaves, tall


grass, or other flammable Never install a sunshade between the
materials. The hot three way upper and lower meters on the
catalytic converter could cause instrument panel. If you do, you could
these materials to catch on fire. cause heat damage to the upper meter
on a very hot day.

212
07/07/11 15:38:30 31SVA620 0218 

Braking System

Your vehicle is equipped with front Constant application of the brakes Braking System Design
disc brakes. The brakes on the rear when going down a long hill builds The hydraulic system that operates
wheels may be disc or drum, up heat and reduces their effective- the brakes has two separate circuits.
depending on the model. A power ness. Use the engine to assist the Each circuit works diagonally across
assist helps reduce the effort needed brakes by taking your foot off the the vehicle (the left-front brake is
on the brake pedal. The anti-lock accelerator and downshifting to a connected with the right-rear brake,
brake system (ABS) helps you retain lower gear. etc.). If one circuit should develop a
steering control when braking very problem, you will still have braking
hard. Check the brakes after driving at two wheels.
through deep water. Apply the
On vehicles with vehicle stability brakes moderately to see if they feel Brake Pad Wear Indicators
assist (VSA) system, the emergency normal. If not, apply them gently and If the brake pads need replacing, you

Driving
brake assist system increases the frequently until they do. Be extra will hear a distinctive, metallic
stopping force when you depress the cautious in your driving. screeching sound when you apply
brake pedal hard in an emergency the brake pedal. If you do not have
situation. the brake pads replaced, they will
screech all the time. It is normal for
Resting your foot on the pedal keeps the brakes to occasionally squeal or
the brakes applied lightly, builds up squeak when you apply them.
heat, and reduces their effectiveness
and reduces brake pad life. In
addition, fuel economy can be
reduced. It also keeps your brake
lights on all the time, confusing
drivers behind you.

213
07/07/11 15:38:36 31SVA620 0219 

Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)

The anti-lock brake system (ABS) You will feel a pulsation in the brake ABS Indicator
helps prevent the wheels from pedal when the ABS activates, and
locking up, and helps you retain you may hear some noise. This is If this indicator comes on, the anti-
steering control by pumping the normal: it is the ABS rapidly lock function of the braking system
brakes rapidly, much faster than a pumping the brakes. On dry has shut down. The brakes still work
person can do it. pavement, you will need to press on like a conventional system, but
the brake pedal very hard before the without anti-lock. You should have
The electronic brake distribution ABS activates. However, you may your dealer inspect your vehicle as
(EBD) system, which is part of the feel the ABS activate immediately if soon as possible.
ABS, also balances the front-to-rear you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
braking distribution according to If the indicator comes on while
vehicle loading. driving, test the brakes as instructed
on page 283 .
You should never pump the brake pedal.
Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the
brake pedal. This is sometimes
referred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’

214
07/07/11 15:38:43 31SVA620 0220 

Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)

If the ABS indicator and the brake Important Safety Reminders A vehicle with ABS may require a
system indicator come on together, ABS does not reduce the time or longer distance to stop on loose or
and the parking brake is fully distance it takes to stop the uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
released, the EBD system may also vehicle. It only helps with the snow, than a vehicle without anti-
be shut down. steering control during braking. lock.

Test your brakes as instructed on ABS will not prevent a skid that
page 283 . If the brakes feel normal, results from changing direction
drive slowly and have your vehicle abruptly, such as trying to take a
repaired by your dealer as soon as corner too fast or making a sudden
possible. Avoid sudden hard braking lane change. Always drive at a safe
which could cause the rear wheels to speed for the road and weather

Driving
lock up and possibly lead to a loss of conditions.
control.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of
On vehicles with VSA system stability. Always steer moderately
The VSA indicator will come on when you are braking hard. Severe
along with the ABS indicator. or sharp steering wheel movement
can still cause your vehicle to veer
into oncoming traffic or off the road.

215
07/07/11 15:38:52 31SVA620 0221 

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

Standard on U.S. Si model The VSA system cannot enhance the If the indicator does not come on
Optional on Canadian Si model vehicle’s driving stability in all when the ignition switch is turned to
The vehicle stability assist (VSA) situations and does not control your the ON (II) position, there may be a
system helps to stabilize the vehicle vehicle’s entire braking system. It is problem with the VSA system. Have
during cornering if the vehicle turns still your responsibility to drive and your dealer inspect your vehicle as
more or less than desired. It also corner at reasonable speeds and to soon as possible.
assists you in maintaining traction leave a sufficient margin of safety.
while accelerating on loose or If the low tire pressure indicator or
slippery road surfaces. It does this VSA Activation Indicator TPMS indicator comes on, the VSA
by regulating the engine’s output and system automatically turns on even if
by selectively applying the brakes. When VSA activates, you will see the the VSA system is turned off by
VSA Activation indicator blinks. pressing the VSA OFF switch (see
When VSA activates, you may notice page 217 ). If this happens, you
that the engine does not respond to Vehicle Stability Assist cannot turn the VSA system off by
the accelerator in the same way it (VSA) System Indicator pressing the VSA off switch again.
does at other times. There may also If this indicator comes on while
be some noise from the VSA driving, pull to the side of the road Without VSA, your vehicle will have
hydraulic system. You will also see when it is safe, and turn off the normal braking and cornering ability,
the VSA activation indicator blink. engine. Reset the system by but it will not have VSA traction and
restarting the engine. If the VSA stability enhancement.
system indicator stays on or comes
back on while driving, have the VSA
system inspected by your dealer.

216
07/07/11 15:39:00 31SVA620 0222 

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

VSA Off Switch VSA is turned on every time you VSA and Tire Sizes
start the engine, even if you turned it Driving with varying tire or wheel
off the last time you drove the sizes may cause the VSA to
vehicle. malfunction. When replacing tires,
make sure they are of the same size
In certain unusual conditions when and type as your original tires (see
your vehicle gets stuck in shallow page 262 ).
mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA temporarily If you install winter tires, make sure
switched off. When the VSA system they are the same size as those that
is off, the traction control system is were originally supplied with your
also off. You should only attempt to vehicle. Exercise the same caution

Driving
free your vehicle with the VSA off if during winter driving as you would if
you are not able to free it when the your vehicle was not equipped with
This switch is under the left vent. VSA is on. VSA.
Press it to turn the VSA system on
and off. Immediately after freeing your
vehicle, be sure to switch the VSA on
When VSA is off, the VSA activation again. We do not recommend driving
indicator comes on as a reminder. your vehicle with the VSA and
traction control systems switched off.

217
07/10/30 14:05:58 31SVA620 0223 

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

U.S. models only Low Tire Pressure Driving on a significantly under-


Your vehicle is equipped with a tire Indicator inflated tire causes the tire to
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) When the low tire pressure indicator overheat and can lead to tire failure.
that turns on every time you start the is on, one or more of your tires is Under-inflation also reduces fuel
engine and monitors the pressure in significantly underinflated. You efficiency and tire tread life, and may
your tires while driving. should stop and check your tires as affect the vehicle’s handling and
soon as possible, and inflate them to stopping ability.
Each tire has its own pressure the proper pressure as indicated on
sensor (not including the spare tire). the vehicle’s tire information placard. Because tire pressure varies by
If the air pressure of a tire becomes temperature and other conditions,
significantly low while driving, the If you think you can safely drive a the low tire pressure indicator may
sensor in that tire immediately sends short distance to a service station, come on unexpectedly.
a signal that causes the low tire proceed slowly, and inflate the tire to
pressure indicator to come on. the recommended pressure shown
on the driver’s doorjamb.

If the tire is flat, or if the tire


pressure is too low to continue
driving, replace the tire with the
compact spare tire (see page 271 ).

If you cannot make the low tire


pressure indicator go out after
inflating the tires to the specified
values, have your dealer check the
system as soon as possible.

218
07/07/11 15:39:18 31SVA620 0224 

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

For example, if you check and fill information label and in the owner’s When you restart the vehicle with
your tires in a warm area, then drive manual (see page 257 ). the compact spare tire, the TPMS
in extremely cold weather, the tire indicator may also come on and stay
pressure will be lower than Tire Pressure Monitoring on after driving several miles
measured and could be underinflated System (TPMS) Indicator (kilometers).
and cause the low tire pressure This indicator comes on and stays on
indicator to come on. Or, if you if there is a problem with the tire
check and adjust your tire pressure pressure monitoring system.
in cooler conditions, and drive into
extremely hot conditions, the tire If this happens, the system will shut
may become overinflated. However, off and no longer monitor tire
the low tire pressure indicator will pressures. Have the system checked

Driving
not come on if the tires are by your dealer as soon as possible.
overinflated.
If the low tire pressure indicator or
Refer to page 255 for tire inflation TPMS indicator comes on, the VSA
guidelines. system automatically turns on even if
the VSA system is turned off by
Although your tire pressure is pressing the VSA OFF switch (see
monitored, you must manually check page 217 ). If this happens, you
the tire pressures monthly. cannot turn the VSA system off by
pressing the VSA off switch again.
Each tire, including the spare, should
be checked monthly when cold, and
set to the recommended inflation
pressure as specified on the tire

219
07/07/11 15:39:26 31SVA620 0225 

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

Changing a Tire with TPMS The low tire pressure indicator or As required by the FCC:
If you have a flat tire, the low tire the TPMS indicator will go off, after This device complies with Part 15 of the
pressure indicator will come on. several miles (kilometers) driving, FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
Replace the flat tire with the when you replace the spare tire with following two conditions: (1) This device
compact spare tire (see page 271 ). the specified regular tire equipped may not cause harmful interference, and
with the tire pressure monitor sensor. (2) this device must accept any
Each wheel (except the compact interference received, including
spare tire wheel) is equipped with a Never use a puncture-repairing agent interference that may cause undesired
tire pressure sensor mounted inside in a flat tire. If used, you will have to operation.
the tire behind the valve stem. You replace the tire pressure sensor.
must use TPMS specific wheels. It is Have the flat tire repaired by your Changes or modifications not expressly
recommended that you always have dealer as soon as possible. approved by the party responsible for
your tires serviced by your dealer or compliance could void the user’s
qualified technician. authority to operate the equipment.

After you replace the flat tire with This device complies with Industry
the compact spare tire, the low tire Canada Standard RSS-210.
pressure indicator stays on. This is Operation is subject to the following two
normal; the system is not monitoring conditions: (1) this device may not cause
the spare tire pressure. Manually interference, and (2) this device must
check the spare tire pressure to be accept any interference that may cause
sure it is correct. After several miles undesired operation of the device.
(kilometers) driving with the
compact spare tire, the TPMS
indicator comes on and the low tire
pressure indicator goes off.

220
07/07/11 15:39:30 31SVA620 0226 

Towing a Trailer

Your vehicle is not designed to tow a Towing Your Vehicle


trailer. Attempting to do so can void Your vehicle is not designed to be
your warranties. towed behind a motor home. If your
vehicle needs to be towed in an
emergency, see page 290 .

Driving
221
07/07/11 15:39:33 31SVA620 0227 

222
07/07/11 15:39:38 31SVA620 0228 

Maintenance

This section explains why it is Maintenance Safety ....................... 224


important to keep your vehicle well Maintenance Minder ..................... 225
maintained and how to follow basic Fluid Locations............................... 232
maintenance safety precautions. Adding Engine Oil ......................... 234
Recommended Engine Oil........ 234
This section also includes Synthetic Oil ............................... 235
instructions on how to read the Engine Oil Additives ................. 235
maintenance minder messages on Changing the Engine Oil and
the information display, and Filter ............................................ 236
instructions for simple maintenance Engine Coolant ............................... 238
tasks you may want to take care of Windshield Washers ..................... 241
yourself. Automatic Transmission Fluid..... 242
Manual Transmission Fluid ......... 243
If you have the skills and tools to Brake and Clutch Fluid ................. 244

Maintenance
perform more complex maintenance Power Steering Fluid..................... 245
tasks on your vehicle, you may want Lights .............................................. 246
to purchase the service manual. See Cleaning the Seat Belts ................. 251
page 315 for information on how to Floor Mats ...................................... 252
obtain a copy, or see your dealer. Dust and Pollen Filter ................... 253
Wiper Blades .................................. 253
Tires ................................................ 255
Checking the Battery .................... 265
Vehicle Storage .............................. 267

223
07/07/11 15:39:47 31SVA620 0229 

Maintenance Safety

All service items not detailed in this Injury from moving parts. Do
section should be performed by a not run the engine unless
certified technician or other qualified Improperly maintaining this instructed to do so.
mechanic. vehicle, or failing to correct a
problem before driving can
Important Safety Precautions cause a crash in which you can
To eliminate potential hazards, read be seriously hurt or killed. Failure to properly follow
the instructions before you begin, maintenance instructions and
and make sure you have the tools Always follow the inspection precautions can cause you to
and skills required. and maintenance be seriously hurt or killed.
Make sure your vehicle is parked recommendations and
on level ground, the parking brake schedules in this owner’s Always follow the procedures
is set, and the engine is off. manual. and precautions in this owner’s
manual.
To clean parts, use a commercially
available degreaser or parts Potential Vehicle Hazards
cleaner, not gasoline. Carbon Monoxide poison from Some of the most important safety
engine exhaust. Be sure there is precautions are given here. However,
To reduce the possibility of fire or adequate ventilation whenever you we cannot warn you of every
explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, operate the engine. conceivable hazard that can arise in
and flames away from the battery performing maintenance. Only you
and all fuel-related parts. Burns from hot parts. Let the can decide whether or not you
engine and exhaust system cool should perform a given task.
Wear eye protection and down before touching any parts.
protective clothing when working
with the battery or compressed air.

224
07/07/11 15:39:55 31SVA620 0230 

Maintenance Minder

Your vehicle displays engine oil life Engine Oil Life Indicator The remaining engine oil life is
and maintenance service items on displayed on the information display
the information display to show you INFORMATION DISPLAY according to this table:
when you should have your dealer
perform engine oil replacement and Calculated Engine Displayed
indicated maintenance service. Oil Life (%) Engine Oil Life (%)
100 % − 91 % 100 %
Based on the engine operating 90 % − 81 % 90 %
conditions and accumulated engine 80 % − 71 % 80 %
revolutions, the onboard computer in 70 % − 61 % 70 %
your vehicle calculates the remaining 60 % − 51 % 60 %
engine oil life and displays it as a MAINTENANCE ENGINE OIL LIFE 50 % − 41 % 50 %
percentage. MINDER INDICATOR INDICATOR 40 % − 31 % 40 %
30 % − 21 % 30 %

Maintenance
To see the current engine oil life, 20 % − 16 % 20 %
turn the ignition switch to the ON 15 % − 11 % *1 15 %
(II) position, then push and release 10 % − 6 % *1 10 %
the SEL/RESET button repeatedly 15 % − 6 % *2 15 %
until the engine oil life indicator 5%−1% 5%
appears (see page 65 ). 0% 0%

*1: DX and Canadian DX-G


*2: LX, EX, EX-L, and Si

CONTINUED

225
07/07/11 15:40:01 31SVA620 0231 

Maintenance Minder

The 15 and 10 percent oil life


indicators remind you that your
vehicle will soon be due for SERVICE MESSAGE
scheduled maintenance.

MAINTENANCE ENGINE OIL LIFE


ITEM CODE(S) INDICATOR

If the remaining engine oil life is 15 When the remaining engine oil life is
to 6 percent, you will see the engine 5 to 1 percent, you will see a
oil life indicator every time you turn ‘‘SERVICE’’ message along with the
the ignition switch to the ON (II) same maintenance item code(s),
position. The maintenance minder every time you turn the ignition
indicator will also come on, and the switch to the ON (II) position.
maintenance item code(s) for other
scheduled maintenance items
needing service will be displayed
next to the engine oil life indicator.

226
07/07/11 15:40:10 31SVA620 0232 

Maintenance Minder

The maintenance item code or codes


indicate the main and sub items
required at the time of the oil change
(see page 231 ).

You can switch the display to the


odometer, the trip meter, and the
outside temperature indicator (if
equipped) by pushing the SEL/
RESET button on the dashboard
repeatedly. NEGATIVE MILEAGE

When the engine oil life is 15 to 1


percent, the maintenance minder

Maintenance
indicator ( ) comes on every When the remaining engine oil life is If you do not perform the indicated
time you turn the ignition switch to 0 percent, the engine oil life indicator maintenance, negative mileage is
the ON (II) position, then it goes out will blink. The display comes on displayed and begins to blink after
if you switch the information display. every time you turn the ignition the vehicle has been driven 10 miles
switch to the ON (II) position. The (10 km) or more.
When you see this message, have maintenance minder indicator Negative mileage means your
the indicated maintenance ( ) also comes on and remains vehicle has passed the maintenance
performed by your dealer as soon as on in the instrument panel. When required point.
possible. you see this message, immediately Immediately have the indicated
have the indicated maintenance done maintenance done by your dealer.
by your dealer.
CONTINUED

227
07/07/11 15:40:19 31SVA620 0233 

Maintenance Minder

You can change the information Maintenance Main Items and Sub Resetting the Engine Oil Life
display from the engine oil life Items Display
display to the odometer, the trip Your dealer will reset the display
meter, or the outside temperature (if MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM after completing the required
equipped) every time you press and maintenance service. You will see
release the SEL/RESET button. ‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the information
display the next time you turn the
When the engine oil life is 0 percent ignition switch to the ON (II)
or negative mileage, the position.
maintenance minder indicator
( ) remains on even if you If maintenance service is done by
change the information display. someone other than your dealer,
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM reset the maintenance minder as
Immediately have the service follows:
performed, and make sure to reset
the display as described on the All maintenance items displayed on 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
following. the information display are in code. (II) position.
For an explanation of these
maintenance codes, see page 231 . 2. Press the SEL/RESET button
repeatedly until the engine oil life
indicator is displayed.

228
07/07/11 15:40:26 31SVA620 0234 

Maintenance Minder

Important Maintenance
Precautions
If you have the required service
done but do not reset the display, or
reset the display without doing the
service, the system will not show the
proper maintenance intervals. This
can lead to serious mechanical
problems because you will no longer
have an accurate record of when
maintenance is needed.

Your authorized Honda dealer


3. Press the SEL/RESET button for 4. Press the SEL/RESET button for knows your vehicle best and can

Maintenance
about 10 seconds. The engine oil more than 5 seconds. The provide competent, efficient service.
life and the maintenance item maintenance item code(s) will
code(s) will blink. disappear, and the engine oil life
will reset to ‘‘100.’’

CONTINUED

229
07/07/11 15:40:36 31SVA620 0235 

Maintenance Minder

However, service at a dealer is not U.S. Vehicles: Maintenance, Engine oil level − Check every
mandatory to keep your warranties replacement, or repair of time you fill the fuel tank. See
in effect. Maintenance may be done emissions control devices and page 189 .
by any qualified service facility or systems may be done by any
person who is skilled in this type of automotive repair establishment Engine coolant level − Check the
automotive service. Make sure to or individual using parts that are radiator reserve tank every time
have the service facility or person ‘‘certified’’ to EPA standards. you fill the fuel tank. See page 191 .
reset the display as previously
described. Keep all receipts as proof According to state and federal Automatic transmission − Check
of completion, and have the person regulations, failure to perform the fluid level monthly. See page
who does the work fill out the maintenance on the items marked 242 .
maintenance record. Check your with # will not void your emissions
warranty booklet for more warranties. However, all Brakes − Check the fluid level
information. maintenance services should be monthly. See page 244 .
performed in accordance with the
We recommend using Honda parts intervals indicated by the Tires − Check the tire pressure
and fluids whenever you have information display. monthly. Examine the tread for
maintenance done. These are wear and foreign objects. See page
manufactured to the same high Owner’s Maintenance Checks 255 .
quality standards as the original You should check the following
components, so you can be confident items at the specified intervals. If Lights − Check the operation of
of their performance and durability. you are unsure of how to perform the headlights, parking lights,
any check, turn to the appropriate taillights, high-mount brake light,
page listed. and license plate lights monthly.
See page 246 .

230
07/07/11 15:40:43 31SVA620 0236 

Maintenance Minder

Symbol Maintenance Main Items Symbol Maintenance Sub Items


A Replace engine oil* 1 Rotate tires
B Replace engine oil* and oil filter 2 Replace air cleaner element
Inspect front and rear brakes If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000
Check parking brake adjustment miles (24,000 km).
Visually inspect these items: Replace dust and pollen filter
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and boots If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high
Suspension components concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
Driveshaft boots from diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000
Brake hoses and line (including ABS) miles (24,000 km).

Maintenance Minder
All fluid levels and condition of fluids Inspect drive belt
Exhaust system# 3 Replace transmission fluid
Fuel lines and connections# 4 Replace spark plugs
Inspect valve clearance
* : If the message ‘‘SERVICE’’ does not appear more than 12 months after the 5 Replace engine coolant
display is reset, change the engine oil every year.

# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty in the center


column on page 230 .

NOTE: Independent of the maintenance minder indicator in the information


display, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).
Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 only if they are noisy.

231
07/10/30 14:06:04 31SVA620 0237 

Fluid Locations

DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, and EX-L models

ENGINE OIL FILL CAP ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK BRAKE FLUID


(Orange handle) (Black cap)

POWER STEERING FLUID* CLUTCH FLUID


(Red cap) (Manual
transmission only)
(Light gray cap)
WASHER FLUID
(Blue cap) AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
FLUID DIPSTICK
(Yellow loop)

ENGINE COOLANT
RESERVOIR

RADIATOR CAP
*: Except for Canadian DX-G with manual transmission

232
07/07/11 15:40:51 31SVA620 0238 

Fluid Locations

Si model

ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK ENGINE OIL FILL CAP BRAKE FLUID


(Orange handle) (Black cap)

CLUTCH FLUID
(Light gray cap)

WASHER FLUID
(Blue cap)

Maintenance
ENGINE COOLANT
RESERVOIR

RADIATOR CAP

233
07/07/11 15:40:58 31SVA620 0239 

Adding Engine Oil

ENGINE OIL FILL CAP ENGINE OIL FILL CAP Recommended Engine Oil
Oil is a major contributor to your
engine’s performance and longevity.
Always use a premium-grade
detergent oil displaying the API
Certification Seal. This seal indicates
the oil is energy conserving, and that
it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements. It is
highly recommended that you use
Honda Motor Oil in your vehicle for
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si optimum engine protection.

Unscrew and remove the engine oil Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and API CERTIFICATION SEAL
fill cap on the valve cover. Pour in tighten it securely. Wait a few
the oil slowly and carefully so you do minutes, and recheck the oil level on
not spill any. Clean up any spills the engine oil dipstick. Do not fill
immediately. Spilled oil could above the upper mark; you could
damage components in the engine damage the engine.
compartment.

234
07/07/11 15:41:08 31SVA620 0240 

Adding Engine Oil

Make sure the API Certification Seal Si model: Synthetic Oil


says ‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’ You may use a synthetic motor oil if
it meets the same requirements
The oil viscosity or weight is given for a conventional motor oil: it
provided on the container’s label. displays the API certification seal,
and it is the proper weight. You must
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, and follow the oil and filter change
EX-L models: intervals shown on the information
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred display.
5W-20 lubricant for your vehicle.
5W-20 oil is formulated for year- Engine Oil Additives
round protection of your vehicle, to Ambient Temperature Your vehicle does not require any oil
improve cold weather starting and additives. Additives may adversely
fuel economy. affect the engine or transmission

Maintenance
An oil with a viscosity of 5W-30 is performance and durability.
preferred for improved fuel economy
and year-round protection in your
vehicle. You may use a 10W-30 oil if
the temperature in your area never
goes below 20°F (−7°C).

Ambient Temperature

235
07/07/11 15:41:15 31SVA620 0241 

Changing the Engine Oil and Filter

Always change the oil and filter DRAIN BOLT WASHER DRAIN BOLT
according to the maintenance WASHER
messages shown on the information
display. The oil and filter collect
contaminants that can damage your
engine if they are not removed
regularly.

Changing the oil and filter requires


special tools and access from
underneath the vehicle. The vehicle
should be raised on a service station- DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si
type hydraulic lift for this service.
Unless you have the knowledge and 1. Run the engine until it reaches 2. Open the hood, and remove the
proper equipment, you should have normal operating temperature, engine oil fill cap. Remove the oil
this maintenance done by a skilled then shut it off. drain bolt and washer from the
technician. bottom of the engine. Drain the oil
into an appropriate container.

236
07/07/11 15:41:26 31SVA620 0242 

Changing the Engine Oil and Filter

OIL FILTER 6. Refill the engine with the


OIL recommended oil.
FILTER
Engine oil change capacity
(including filter):

DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L


3.9 US qt (3.7 )

Si
4.6 US qt (4.4 )

DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si 7. Replace the engine oil fill cap.
Start the engine. The oil pressure
3. Remove the oil filter, and let the 4. Install a new oil filter according to indicator should go out within 5

Maintenance
remaining oil drain. A special the instructions that come with it. seconds. If it does not, turn off the
wrench (available from your engine, and check your work.
dealer) is required. Make sure to clean off any dirt
and dust on the connecting 8. Let the engine run for several
Make sure the oil filter gasket is surface of a new oil filter. minutes, then check the drain bolt
not stuck to the engine block. If it and oil filter for leaks.
is, remove it before installing a 5. Put a new washer on the drain bolt,
new oil filter. then reinstall the drain bolt.
Tighten the drain bolt to:
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)

CONTINUED

237
07/07/11 15:41:33 31SVA620 0243 

Changing the Engine Oil and Filter, Engine Coolant

9. Turn off the engine, let it sit for Adding Engine Coolant
several minutes, then check the oil
level on the dipstick. If necessary, RESERVE TANK RESERVE TANK
add more oil.

Improper disposal of engine oil can be


harmf ul to the environment. If you
change your own oil, please dispose of
the used oil properly. Put it in a sealed
container and take it to a recycling
center. Do not discard it in a trash bin DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si
or dump it on the ground.
If the coolant level in the reserve Always use Honda Long-life Anti-
tank is at or below the MIN line, add freeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolant
coolant to bring it up to the MAX line. is pre-mixed with 50 percent
Inspect the cooling system for leaks. antifreeze and 50 percent water.
Never add straight antifreeze or
plain water.

238
07/07/11 15:41:40 31SVA620 0244 

Engine Coolant

If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not


available, you may use another
major-brand non-silicate coolant as a Removing the radiator cap RADIATOR CAP
temporary replacement. Make sure it while the engine is hot can
is a high-quality coolant cause the coolant to spray out,
recommended for aluminum engines. seriously scalding you.
Continued use of any non-Honda
coolant can result in corrosion, Always let the engine and
causing the cooling system to radiator cool down before
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling removing the radiator cap.
system flushed and refilled with
Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible. DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L

Maintenance
If the reserve tank is completely 1. Make sure the engine and radiator
empty, you should also check the are cool.
coolant level in the radiator.
2. Relieve any pressure in the cooling
system by turning the radiator cap
counterclockwise, without
pressing down.

CONTINUED

239
07/07/11 15:41:48 31SVA620 0245 

Engine Coolant

RADIATOR CAP RESERVE TANK RESERVE TANK

Si DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si

3. Remove the radiator cap by 4. The coolant level should be up to 6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank.
pushing down and turning the base of the filler neck. Add Fill it to halfway between the MAX
counterclockwise. coolant if it is low. and MIN marks. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.
Pour the coolant slowly and
carefully so you do not spill any. Do not add any rust inhibitors or
Clean up any spill immediately; it other additives to your vehicle’s
could damage components in the cooling system. They may not be
engine compartment. compatible with the coolant or
engine components.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and
tighten it fully.

240
07/07/11 15:41:56 31SVA620 0246 

Windshield Washers

Check the fluid level in the LEVEL GAUGE When you refill the reservoir, clean
windshield washer reservoir at least the edges of the windshield wiper
monthly during normal use. blades with windshield washer fluid
on a clean cloth. This will help to
LEVEL GAUGE condition the blade edges.

Do not use engine antif reeze or a


vinegar/water solution in the
windshield washer reservoir. Antif reeze
Si can damage your vehicle’s paint, while
a vinegar/water solution can damage
On Canadian models: The low washer the windshield washer pump. Use only

Maintenance
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L level indicator comes on when the commercially-available windshield
level is low (see page 63 ). washer f luid.
Check the fluid level by removing
the cap and looking at the level Fill the reservoir with a good-quality
gauge. windshield washer fluid. This
increases the cleaning capability and
prevents freezing in cold weather.

241
07/07/11 15:42:07 31SVA620 0247 

Automatic Transmission Fluid

DIPSTICK 5. If the level is below the lower


mark, add fluid into the dipstick
hole to bring it to the level
between the upper and lower
marks.
UPPER Pour the fluid slowly and carefully
MARK so you do not spill any. Clean up
LOWER
MARK any spill immediately; it could
damage components in the engine
compartment.

Always use Honda ATF-Z1


Check the fluid level with the engine 2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) (automatic transmission fluid).
at normal operating temperature. from the transmission, and wipe it
with a clean cloth. 6. Insert the dipstick all the way back
1. Park the vehicle on level ground. into the transmission securely as
Start the engine, let it run until the 3. Insert the dipstick all the way into shown in the illustration.
radiator fan comes on, then shut the transmission securely as
off the engine. For accurate shown in the illustration. The transmission should be drained
results, wait about 60 seconds (but and refilled with new fluid according
no longer than 90 seconds) before 4. Remove the dipstick, and check to the maintenance minder (see page
doing step 2. the fluid level. It should be 225 ).
between the upper and lower
marks. If you are not sure how to add fluid,
contact your dealer.

242
07/07/11 15:42:15 31SVA620 0248 

Automatic Transmission Fluid, Manual Transmission Fluid

Manual Transmission Fluid

Use only Honda Genuine ATF-Z1 FILLER BOLT FILLER BOLT


(Automatic Transmission Fluid). Do
not mix with other transmission f luids.
Using transmission f luid other than
Honda Genuine ATF-Z1 may cause
deterioration in transmission operation
and durability, and could result in
damage to the transmission.
Damage resulting f rom the use of
transmission f luid other than Honda Correct Level
Genuine ATF-Z1 is not covered by the DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si Correct Level
Honda new vehicle warranty.

Maintenance
Check the fluid level with the If Honda MTF is not available, you
transmission at normal operating may use an SAE 10W-30 or 10W-40
temperature and the vehicle sitting viscosity motor oil with the API
on level ground. Remove the Certification seal that says ‘‘FOR
transmission filler bolt, and carefully GASOLINE ENGINES’’ as a
feel inside the bolt hole with your temporary replacement. However,
finger. The fluid level should be up motor oil does not contain the proper
to the edge of the bolt hole. If it is additives, and continued use can
not, add Honda Manual cause stiffer shifting. Replace as
Transmission Fluid (MTF) until it soon as it is convenient.
starts to run out of the hole. Reinstall
the filler bolt, and tighten it securely. CONTINUED

243
07/07/11 15:42:24 31SVA620 0249 

Manual Transmission Fluid, Brake and Clutch Fluid

The transmission should be drained Brake and Clutch Fluid Brake System
and refilled with new fluid according Check the brake fluid level in the
to the maintenance minder (see page reservoirs monthly. MAX
225 ).
Replace the brake fluid according to
If you are not sure how to check and the maintenance minder (see page
add fluid, contact your dealer. 225 ).

Always use Honda Heavy Duty


Brake Fluid DOT 3. If it is not
available, you should use only DOT 3
or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealed
container, as a temporary MIN
replacement.
The fluid level should be between
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can the MIN and MAX marks on the side
cause corrosion and decrease the life of the reservoir. If the level is at or
of the system. Have the brake below the MIN mark, your brake
system flushed and refilled with system needs attention. Have the
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid brake system inspected for leaks or
DOT 3 as soon as possible. worn brake pads.

Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not


compatible with your vehicle’s
braking system and can cause
extensive damage.

244
07/10/30 14:08:01 31SVA620 0250 

Brake and Clutch Fluid, Power Steering Fluid

Clutch Fluid Power Steering Fluid Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so
Manual Transmission only you do not spill any. Clean up any
UPPER LEVEL spill immediately; it could damage
MAX components in the engine
compartment.

Always use Honda Power Steering


Fluid. You may use another power
steering fluid as an emergency
replacement, but have the power
steering system flushed and refilled
with Honda PSF as soon as possible.
LOWER LEVEL
MIN A low power steering fluid level can

Maintenance
All models except Si and Canadian DX-G indicate a leak in the system. Check
The fluid level should be between with manual transmission the fluid level frequently, and have
the MIN and MAX marks on the side Check the level on the side of the the system inspected as soon as
of the reservoir. If it is not, add reservoir when the engine is cold. possible.
brake fluid to bring it up to that level. The fluid should be between the
Use the same fluid specified for the UPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL.
brake system. If not add power steering fluid to the
UPPER LEVEL mark. Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef t
A low fluid level can indicate a leak or right lock and holding it there can
in the clutch system. Have this damage the power steering pump.
system inspected as soon as possible.

245
07/07/11 15:42:41 31SVA620 0251 

Lights

Headlight Aiming Replacing a Headlight Bulb High Beam Headlight


The headlights were properly aimed Your vehicle has halogen headlight
when your vehicle was new. If you bulbs. When replacing a bulb, handle CLIP COOLANT
TUBE
regularly carry heavy items in the it by its base, and protect the glass
trunk, readjustment may be required. from contact with your skin or hard
Adjustments should be done by your objects. If you touch the glass, clean
dealer or other qualified technician. it with denatured alcohol and a clean
cloth.

Halogen headlight bulbs get very hot


when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch
on the glass can cause the bulb to
overheat and shatter. 1. Open the hood.

To change a bulb on the driver’s


side, remove the coolant tube from
the two clips, then remove the
reserve tank from its holder by
pulling it straight up.

246
07/07/11 15:42:50 31SVA620 0252 

Lights

4. Insert the new bulb into the hole,


and turn it one-quarter turn
clockwise to lock it in place.

5. Push the electrical connector back


onto the bulb. Make sure it is on
all the way.

6. Turn on the headlights to test the


BULB
new bulb.

7. (Driver’s side)
HOLDER TAB CONNECTOR Put the tube back in the clips and
install the reserve tank back in

Maintenance
2. Remove the electrical connector place, making sure its bottom tab
from the bulb by pushing on the is in the holder.
tab to unlock it, then slide the
connector off the bulb.

3. Remove the bulb by turning it


about one-quarter turn
counterclockwise.

CONTINUED

247
07/07/11 15:42:59 31SVA620 0253 

Lights

Low Beam Headlight 4. Remove the bulb from the


headlight assembly by turning it
SCREW BULB one-quarter turn counterclockwise.

5. Insert the new bulb into the hole,


and turn it one-quarter turn
clockwise to lock it in place.

6. Push the electrical connector back


onto the bulb. Make sure it is on
all the way.

ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR 7. Turn on the headlights to test the


new bulb.
1. To change the driver’s side bulb, 2. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to
start the engine, turn the steering remove the screw from the inner 8. Reinstall the inner fender cover.
wheel all the way to the right, and fender, and pull the inner fender Then reinstall the screw and
turn off the engine. To change the cover back. tighten it securely.
passenger’s side bulb, turn the
steering wheel to the left. 3. Remove the electrical connector
from the bulb by pushing on the
tab to unlock it, then slide the
connector off the bulb.

248
07/07/11 15:43:08 31SVA620 0254 

Lights

Replacing the Front Side Marker/ 4. Remove the bulb from the socket
Parking/Turn Signal Light Bulb by pushing the bulb in and turning
it counterclockwise until it unlocks.

5. Install the new bulb in the socket.


Turn it clockwise to lock it in place.

6. Insert the socket back into the


headlight assembly. Turn it
clockwise to lock it in place.

7. Turn on the lights to make sure


the new bulb is working.

Maintenance
8. Reinstall the inner fender cover.
1. To change the driver’s side bulb, 2. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to Then reinstall the screw and
start the engine, turn the steering remove the screw from the inner tighten it securely.
wheel all the way to the right, and fender, and pull the inner fender
turn off the engine. To change the cover back.
passenger’s side bulb, turn the
steering wheel to the left. 3. Remove the socket from the
headlight assembly by turning it
one-quarter turn counterclockwise.

249
07/07/11 15:43:18 31SVA620 0255 

Lights

Replacing Rear Bulbs 4. Pull the bulb straight out of its


socket. Push the new bulb straight
into the socket until it bottoms.

5. Reinstall the socket into the light


assembly by turning it clockwise
until it locks.

6. Turn on the lights to make sure


the new bulb is working.

7. Reinstall the trunk lining. Make


FASTENER sure it is installed under the edge
of the trunk seal.
1. Open the trunk. 2. Determine which of the four bulbs
is burned out: stop/tail-light, back- 8. Put the fastener into the hole on
Remove the screw in the center of up light, side marker light, or turn the side of the trunk lining.
the fastener on the side of the signal light. Reinstall the screw.
trunk lining. Pull the lining back.
3. Remove the socket by turning it
one-quarter turn counterclockwise.

250
07/07/11 15:43:27 31SVA620 0256 

Lights, Cleaning the Seat Belts

Replacing a High-mount Brake Cleaning the Seat Belts


Light Bulb
On DX, Canadian DX-G, and LX models LOOP
1. Open the trunk, then remove the
holding clips from the cover, and
remove the cover.

2. Remove the socket from the light BULB


assembly by turning it one-quarter
turn counterclockwise.
SOCKET

3. Pull the bulb straight out of its

Maintenance
socket. Push the new bulb straight If your seat belts get dirty, use a soft
into the socket until it bottoms. brush with a mixture of mild soap
and warm water to clean them. Do
4. Reinstall the socket. Turn it not use bleach, dye, or cleaning
clockwise until it locks. Make sure solvents. Let the belts air-dry before
the new bulb is working. you use the vehicle.

5. Reinstall the cover, and tighten its


holding clips securely.

CONTINUED

251
07/07/11 15:43:34 31SVA620 0257 

Cleaning the Seat Belts, Floor Mats

Dirt build-up in the loops of the seat Floor Mats If you remove a floor mat, make sure
belt anchors can cause the belts to to re-anchor it when you put it back
retract slowly. Wipe the insides of in your vehicle.
the loops with a clean cloth
dampened in mild soap and warm If you use a non-Honda floor mat,
water or isopropyl alcohol. make sure it fits properly and that it
can be used with the floor mat
anchors. Do not put additional floor
mats on top of the anchored mat.

If equipped
The driver’s floor mat that came
with your vehicle hooks over the
floor mat anchors. This keeps the
floor mat from sliding forward and
possibly interfering with the pedals.

252
07/07/11 15:43:43 31SVA620 0258 

Dust and Pollen Filter, Wiper Blades

Dust and Pollen Filter Wiper Blades


On models with A/C Check the condition of the wiper
This filter removes the dust and blades at least every six months.
pollen that is brought in from the Replace them if you find signs of
outside through the heating and cracking in the rubber, areas that are
cooling system. getting hard, or if they leave streaks
and unwiped areas when used.
Have your dealer replace the filter
when this service is indicated by a
maintenance message on the
information display. It should be
replaced every 15,000 miles (24,000
km) if you drive primarily in urban
areas that have high concentrations To replace a wiper blade:

Maintenance
of soot in the air, or if the flow from
the heating and cooling system 1. Raise each wiper arm off the
becomes less than usual. windshield, lifting the driver’s side
first, then the passenger’s side.

Do not open the hood when the wiper


arms are raised, or you will damage the
hood and wiper arms.

CONTINUED

253
07/07/11 15:43:49 31SVA620 0259 

Wiper Blades

RELEASE TAB BLADE

HOLDER

RELEASE BUTTON COVER

2. Disconnect the blade assembly 3. Pull up the cover release tab on 4. Slide the blade out of the holder.
from the wiper arm by pushing in the end of the blade assembly,
the release button. Then slide the then remove the cover.
blade assembly out of the wiper
arm.

254
07/07/11 15:43:59 31SVA620 0260 

Wiper Blades, Tires

5. Align the slots in the new blade Tires Inflation Guidelines


with the retaining edges on the To safely operate your vehicle, your Keeping the tires properly inflated
holder, then slide the blade onto tires must be the proper type and provides the best combination of
the holder. Keep about 1 inch of size, in good condition with adequate handling, tread life, and riding
the holder extended from the tread, and correctly inflated. comfort.
blade assembly so you can
reinstall the cover. The following pages give more Underinflated tires wear unevenly,
detailed information on how to take adversely affect handling and fuel
6. Reinstall the cover onto the blade care of your tires and what to do economy, and are more likely to
assembly. when they need to be replaced. fail from being overheated.

7. Slide the wiper blade assembly Overinflated tires can make your
onto the wiper arm. Make sure it vehicle ride more harshly, are
locks in place. Using tires that are excessively more prone to damage from road

Maintenance
worn or improperly inflated can hazards, and wear unevenly.
8. Lower the wiper arm down against cause a crash in which you can
the windshield, the passenger’s be seriously hurt or killed.
side first, then the driver’s side.
Follow all instructions in this
owner’s manual regarding tire
inflation and maintenance.

CONTINUED

255
07/07/11 15:44:06 31SVA620 0261 

Tires

We recommend that you visually Use a gauge to measure the air If you check air pressures when the
check your tires every day. If you pressure in each tire at least once a tires are hot [driven for several miles
think a tire might be low, check it month. Even tires that are in good (kilometers)], you will see readings 4
immediately with a tire gauge. condition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4
20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per kgf/cm ) higher than the cold
The tire pressure monitoring system month. Remember to check the readings. This is normal. Do not let
(TPMS) warns you when a tire spare tire at the same time. air out to match the recommended
pressure is low. See page 218 for cold air pressure. The tire will be
more information. Check the air pressures when the underinflated.
tires are cold. This means the
Even though your vehicle is vehicle has been parked for at least 3 You should get your own tire
equipped with TPMS, we hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 pressure gauge and use it whenever
recommend that you visually check km). Add or release air, if needed, to you check your tire pressures. This
your tires every day. match the recommended cold tire will make it easier for you to tell if a
pressures on this page. pressure loss is due to a tire problem
and not due to a variation between
gauges.

While tubeless tires have some


ability to self-seal if they are
punctured, you should look closely
for punctures if a tire starts losing
pressure.

256
07/10/30 14:08:21 31SVA620 0262 

Tires

Recommended Tire Pressures Si competitive event at sustained high


The following charts show the Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure speeds (over 118 mph or 190 km/h),
recommended cold tire pressures for Front/Rear be sure to adjust the cold tire
most normal driving conditions. P215/45R17 87V 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 pressures as shown below. If you do
kgf/cm ) not, excessive heat can build up and
DX and Canadian DX-G with automatic cause sudden tire failure.
transmission Optional Summer Tire for Si
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure Tire Size·Cold Tire Pressure for High
Front/Rear 215/45ZR17 91W 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 Speed Driving
P195/65R15 89H 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) Si model only
kgf/cm ) P215/45R17 87V
The compact spare tire pressure is:
Canadian DX-G with manual transmission 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) Front/Rear:
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure 35 psi (240 kPa , 2.4 kgf/cm )

Maintenance
Front/Rear For convenience, the recommended
P195/65R15 89S 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 tire sizes and cold tire pressures are When you return to normal speed
kgf/cm ) on a label on the driver’s doorjamb. driving, be sure to readjust the tire
For additional information about pressure for normal driving. You
LX, EX, EX-L your tires, see page 299 . should wait until the tires are cold
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure before adjusting the tire pressure.
Front/Rear High Speed Driving
P205/55R16 89H 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 Si model only Except Si model
kgf/cm ) We strongly recommend that you do Tire pressure for high speed driving
not drive faster than the posted is the same as for normal driving.
speed limits and conditions allow. If
you ever drive in a sanctioned

257
07/07/11 15:44:31 31SVA620 0263 

Tires

Tire Inspection INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS Tire Service Life


Every time you check inflation, you The service life of your tires is
should also examine the tires for dependent on many factors,
damage, foreign objects, and wear. including, but not limited to, driving
habits, road conditions, vehicle
You should look for: loading, inflation pressure,
Bumps or bulges in the tread or maintenance history, speed, and
side of the tire. Replace the tire if environmental conditions (even
you find either of these conditions. when the tires are not in use).

Cuts, splits, or cracks in the side In addition to your regular


of the tire. Replace the tire if you TREAD WEAR INDICATOR inspections and inflation pressure
can see fabric or cord. maintenance, it is recommended that
Your tires have wear indicators you have annual inspections

Maintenance
Excessive tread wear. molded into the tread. When the performed once the tires reach five
tread wears down, you will see a 1/2 years old. It is also recommended
inch (12.7 mm) wide band across the that all tires, including the spare, be
tread. This shows there is less than removed from service after 10 years
1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left on from the date of manufacture,
the tire. regardless of their condition or state
of wear.
A tire this worn gives very little
traction on wet roads. You should
replace the tire if you can see three
or more tread wear indicators.

258
07/07/11 15:44:37 31SVA620 0264 

Tires

The last four digits of the TIN (tire Tire Maintenance


identification number) are found on In addition to proper inflation,
the sidewall of the tire and indicate correct wheel alignment helps to For vehicles equipped with aluminum
the date of manufacture (See Tire decrease tire wear. If you find a tire wheels:
Labeling on page 301 ). is worn unevenly, have your dealer Improper wheel weights can damage
check the wheel alignment. your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use
only Honda wheel weights f or
Have your dealer check the tires if balancing.
you feel a consistent vibration while
driving. A tire should always be
rebalanced if it is removed from the
wheel. When you have new tires
installed, make sure they are
balanced. This increases riding
comfort and tire life. For best results,
have the installer perform a dynamic
balance.

259
07/07/11 15:44:45 31SVA620 0265 

Tires

Tire Rotation When the tires are rotated, make The mileage you can expect from
sure the air pressures are checked. your vehicle tires is the same as
Front Front comparable mid-and rear-engine
Tire Wear sports cars, and it will vary greatly
Si model only with your driving habits.
The tires that came on your vehicle
were designed and constructed to If you drive moderately, the front
provide superior grip during tires could last more than 10,000
acceleration, braking, and cornering. miles (16,000 km). However, the
mileage will be substantially less if
As a trade-off, they will wear more you tend to drive your vehicle at the
(For Non-directional (For Directional rapidly than tires used on ordinary upper limits of its capabilities.
Tires and Wheels) Tires and Wheels) passenger vehicles. Because of the
vehicle’s weight distribution, and the You should carefully inspect your
To help increase tire life and fact that the front wheels are the vehicle’s tires for wear, damage, and
distribute wear more evenly, rotate driving wheels, you can expect them proper inflation every 7,500 miles
the tires according to the to wear more rapidly than the rear (12,000 km).
maintenance messages displayed on tires.
the information display.
Move the tires to the positions
shown in the illustration each time
they are rotated. If you purchase
directional tires, rotate only front-to-
back.

260
07/07/11 15:44:52 31SVA620 0266 

Tires

Replacing Tires and Wheels It is best to replace all four tires at


Replace your tires with radial tires of the same time. If that is not possible
the same size, load range, speed or necessary, replace the two front Installing improper tires on your
rating, and maximum cold tire tires or two rear tires as a pair. vehicle can affect handling and
pressure rating (as shown on the Replacing just one tire can seriously stability. This can cause a crash
tire’s sidewall). affect your vehicle’s handling. in which you can be seriously
hurt or killed.
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires on If you ever replace a wheel, make
your vehicle can reduce braking sure that the wheel’s specifications Always use the size and type of
ability, traction, and steering match those of the original wheels. tires recommended in this
accuracy. Using tires of a different owner’s manual.
size or construction can cause the On vehicles with TPMS
ABS and vehicle stability assist Also be sure you use only TPMS
system (VSA) to work inconsistently. specific wheels. If you do not, the

Maintenance
tire pressure monitoring system will
The ABS and VSA system (if not work.
equipped) work by comparing the
speed of each wheel. When replacing Replacement wheels are available at
tires, use the same size originally your dealer.
supplied with the vehicle. Tire size
and construction can affect wheel
speed and may cause the system to
activate.

261
07/10/30 14:08:33 31SVA620 0267 

Tires

Wheel and Tire Specifications Tires: Winter Driving


Wheels: DX and Canadian DX-G with Tires marked ‘‘M + S’’ or ‘‘All
DX and Canadian DX-G automatic transmission Season’’ on the sidewall have an all-
15 x 6 J P195/65R15 89H weather tread design suitable for
most winter driving conditions.
LX, EX, EX-L Canadian DX-G with manual
16 x 6 1/2 J transmission For the best performance in snowy
P195/65R15 89S or icy conditions, you should install
Si snow tires or tire chains. They may
17 x 7 J LX, EX, EX-L be required by local laws under
P205/55R16 89H certain conditions.

Si Summer Tires
P215/45R17 87V Si model only
(all season tire) If your vehicle is equipped with
Optional summer tires, be aware that these
215/45ZR17 91W tires are not designed for winter
(summer tire) driving conditions. For more
information, consult your dealer.
See page 299 for information about
DOT Tire Quality Grading, and page
301 for tire size and labeling
information.

262
07/07/11 15:45:10 31SVA620 0268 

Tires

Snow Tires Tire Chains Because your vehicle has limited tire
If you mount snow tires on your Mount tire chains on your tires when clearance, Honda strongly
vehicle, make sure they are radial required by driving conditions or recommends using the chains listed
tires of the same size and load range local laws. Install them only on the below, made by Security Chain
as original tires. Mount snow tires on front tires. Company (SCC).
all four wheels. The traction
provided by snow tires on dry roads When installing chains, follow the Cable-type: SCC Radial Chain
may be lower than your original tires. manufacturer’s instructions, and CH2311T
Check with the tire dealer for mount them as tight as you can.
maximum speed recommendations. Make sure they are not contacting
the brake lines or suspension. Drive
slowly with them installed. If you
hear them coming into contact with
the body or chassis, stop and

Maintenance
investigate. Remove them as soon as
you begin driving on cleared roads.

CONTINUED

263
07/07/11 15:45:16 31SVA620 0269 

Tires

Wheels
Clean the wheels as you would the
Traction devices that are the wrong Using the wrong chains, or not rest of the exterior. Wash them with
size or improperly installed can properly installing chains, can the same solution, and rinse them
damage your vehicle’s brake lines, damage the brake lines and thoroughly.
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop cause a crash in which you can
driving if they are hitting any part of be seriously injured or killed. If equipped
the vehicle. Aluminum alloy wheels have a
Follow all instructions in this protective clear-coat that keeps the
owner’s manual regarding the aluminum from corroding and
selection and use of tire chains. tarnishing. Cleaning the wheels with
harsh chemicals (including some
commercial wheel cleaners) or a stiff
brush can damage the clear-coat. To
clean the wheels, use a mild
detergent and a soft brush or sponge.

264
07/07/11 15:45:24 31SVA620 0270 

Checking the Battery

TEST INDICATOR WINDOW TEST INDICATOR WINDOW If additional battery maintenance is


needed, see your dealer or a
qualified technician.

WARNING: Battery posts,


terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.

DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si

Check the condition of the battery Check the terminals for corrosion (a

Maintenance
monthly by looking at the test white or yellowish powder). To
indicator window. The label on the remove it, cover the terminals with a
battery explains the test indicator’s solution of baking soda and water. It
colors. will bubble up and turn brown. When
this stops, wash it off with plain
The location of the test indicator water. Dry off the battery with a
window varies between cloth or paper towel. Coat the
manufacturers. terminals with grease to help prevent
further corrosion.

CONTINUED

265
07/07/11 15:45:29 31SVA620 0271 

Checking the Battery

If you need to connect the battery to If your vehicle’s battery is


a charger, disconnect both cables to disconnected or goes dead, the audio
prevent damaging your vehicle’s system may disable itself. The next
electrical system. Always disconnect time you turn on the radio, you will
the negative (−) cable first, and see ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in the
reconnect it last. frequency display. Use the preset
buttons to enter the code (see page
179 ).

The battery gives off explosive On vehicles with navigation system


hydrogen gas during normal The navigation system will also
operation. disable itself. The next time you turn
on the ignition switch, the system
A spark or flame can cause the will require you to enter a PIN
battery to explode with enough before it can be used. Refer to the
force to kill or seriously hurt you. navigation system manual.

Wear protective clothing and a


face shield, or have a skilled
technician do the battery
maintenance.

266
07/07/11 15:45:38 31SVA620 0272 

Vehicle Storage

If you need to park your vehicle for Block the rear wheels. Cover the vehicle with a
an extended period (more than 1 ‘‘breathable’’ cover, one made
month), there are several things you If the vehicle is to be stored for a from a porous material such as
should do to prepare it for storage. longer period, it should be cotton. Non-porous materials, such
Proper preparation helps prevent supported on jackstands so the as plastic sheeting, trap moisture,
deterioration and makes it easier to tires are off the ground. which can damage the paint.
get your vehicle back on the road. If
possible, store your vehicle indoors. Leave one window open slightly (if If possible, periodically run the
the vehicle is being stored engine until it reaches full
Fill the fuel tank. indoors). operating temperature (the
cooling fans cycle on and off
Wash and dry the exterior Disconnect the battery. twice). Preferably, do this once a
completely. month.
Support the front wiper blade

Maintenance
Clean the interior. Make sure the arms with a folded towel or rag so
carpeting, floor mats, etc., are they do not touch the windshield.
completely dry.
To minimize sticking, apply a
Leave the parking brake off. Put silicone spray lubricant to all door
the transmission in reverse and trunk seals. Also, apply a
(manual) or Park (automatic). vehicle body wax to the painted
surfaces that mate with the door
and trunk seals.

267
07/07/11 15:45:41 31SVA620 0273 

268
07/07/11 15:45:44 31SVA620 0274 

Taking Care of the Unexpected

This section covers the more Compact Spare Tire....................... 270


common problems that motorists Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 271
experience with their vehicles. It If the Engine Won’t Start .............. 275
gives you information about how to Jump Starting ................................. 277
safely evaluate the problem and what If the Engine Overheats ............... 279
to do to correct it. If the problem has Low Oil Pressure Indicator .......... 281
stranded you on the side of the road, Charging System Indicator........... 281
you may be able to get going again. Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 282
If not, you will also find instructions Brake System Indicator ................ 283
on getting your vehicle towed. Fuses ............................................... 284
Fuse Locations ............................... 288
Emergency Towing ....................... 290

Taking Care of the Unexpected


269
07/07/11 15:45:54 31SVA620 0275 

Compact Spare Tire

Use the compact spare tire as a Do not mount tire chains on the INDICATOR LOCATION MARK
temporary replacement only. Get compact spare tire.
your regular tire repaired or replaced,
and put it back on your vehicle as Do not use your compact spare
soon as you can. tire on another vehicle unless it is
the same make and model.
Check the inflation pressure of the
compact spare tire every time you On Si model
check the other tires. It should be Do not use a compact spare tire
inflated to: mounted on a front wheel; it will
damage the limited slip differential
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) (see page 271 ). TREAD WEAR INDICATOR

Follow these precautions: All U.S. models Replace the tire when you can see
The low tire pressure indicator the tread wear indicator bars. The
Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h). comes on and stays on after you replacement should be the same size
replace the flat tire with the and design tire, mounted on the
This tire gives a harsher ride and compact spare tire. After several same wheel. The spare tire is not
less traction on some road miles (kilometers) driving with the designed to be mounted on a regular
surfaces. Use greater caution compact spare tire, the TPMS wheel, and the spare wheel is not
while driving. indicator comes on and the low designed for mounting a regular tire.
tire pressure indicator goes off.

270
07/07/11 15:46:04 31SVA620 0276 

Changing a Flat Tire

If you have a flat tire while driving, JACK TOOL CASE


stop in a safe place to change it.
Drive slowly along the shoulder until The vehicle can easily roll off
you get to an exit or an area that is the jack, seriously injuring
far away from the traffic lanes. anyone underneath.

The compact spare tire is smaller Follow the directions for


than a standard tire, and it will affect changing a tire exactly, and
the vehicle’s handling. Drive never get under the vehicle
cautiously when the spare is when it is supported only by the
mounted on your vehicle. jack.
TRUNK FLOOR SPARE TIRE
On Si model only
The size difference may also cause 1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and 3. Open the trunk. Raise the trunk
damage to the differential, so do not non-slippery ground. Put the floor by lifting up on the back edge.
mount the compact spare on the transmission in Park (automatic)

Taking Care of the Unexpected


front. If either front tire goes flat, or reverse (manual). Apply the 4. Take the tool kit case out of the
remove the rear tire on that same parking brake. trunk.
side, mount the compact spare tire
on the rear, then mount the rear tire 2. Turn on the hazard warning lights, 5. Unscrew the wing bolt, and take
on the front. and turn the ignition switch to the the spare tire out of its well.
LOCK (0) position. Have all
passengers get out of the vehicle
while you change the tire.

CONTINUED

271
07/07/11 19:57:11 31SVA620 0277 

Changing a Flat Tire

JACKING POINTS

WHEEL NUT WRENCH

6. Canadian DX-G model 7. Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turn 8. Place the jack under the jacking
Remove the center cap from the with the wheel nut wrench. point nearest the tire you need to
wheel with the extension. change. Turn the end bracket
clockwise until the top of the jack
contacts the jacking point. Make
sure the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.

272
07/07/11 19:57:20 31SVA620 0278 

Changing a Flat Tire

WHEEL NUTS

WHEEL NUT WRENCH EXTENSION WHEEL NUTS WHEEL COVER BRAKE HUB

9. Use the extension and the wheel DX, and U.S. LX models 11. Before mounting the spare tire,
nut wrench as shown to raise the Do not attempt to forcibly pry the wipe any dirt off the mounting
vehicle until the flat tire is off the wheel cover off with a screwdriver surface of the wheel and hub with

Taking Care of the Unexpected


ground. or other tool. The wheel cover a clean cloth. Wipe the hub
cannot be removed without first carefully; it may be hot from
10. Remove the wheel nuts, then removing the wheel nuts. driving.
remove the flat tire. Handle the
wheel nuts carefully; they may be
hot from driving. Place the flat tire
on the ground with the outside
surface facing up.

CONTINUED

273
07/07/11 15:46:26 31SVA620 0279 

Changing a Flat Tire

12. Put on the spare tire. Put the 14. Tighten the wheel nuts securely in 15. On EX, EX-L and Si models in the U.S.,
wheel nuts back on finger-tight, the same crisscross pattern. Have and LX, EX, EX-L and Si models in
then tighten them in a crisscross the wheel nut torque checked at Canada
pattern with the wheel nut wrench the nearest automotive service Remove the center cap from the
until the wheel is firmly against facility. flat tire.
the hub. Do not try to tighten the
wheel nuts fully. Tighten the wheel nuts to:
80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)
13. Lower the vehicle to the ground,
and remove the jack.

274
07/07/11 15:46:37 31SVA620 0280 

Changing a Flat Tire, If the Engine Won’t Start

SPACER CONE WING BOLT


If the Engine Won’t Start
Diagnosing why the engine won’t
Loose items can fly around the start falls into two areas, depending
interior in a crash and could on what you hear when you turn the
seriously injure the occupants. ignition switch to the START (III)
position:
Store the wheel, jack, and tools
securely before driving. You hear nothing, or almost
For For normal nothing. The engine’s starter
compact tire motor does not operate at all, or
spare tire 20. Store the wheel cover or center operates very slowly.
cap in the trunk. Make sure it does
not get scratched or damaged. You can hear the starter motor
16. Place the flat tire face down in the operating normally, or the starter
spare tire well. 21. Lower the trunk floor, then close motor sounds like it is spinning
the trunk lid. faster than normal, but the engine

Taking Care of the Unexpected


17. Remove the spacer cone from the does not start up and run.
wing bolt, turn it over, and put it 22. On all U.S. models
back on the bolt. Your vehicle’s original tire has a
tire pressure monitoring system
18. Secure the flat tire by screwing sensor. To replace a tire, refer to
the wing bolt back into its hole. Changing a Tire with TPMS (see
page 220 ).
19. Store the jack and tools in the tool
kit case. Place the tool kit case in
the center of the flat tire.

275
07/07/11 15:46:47 31SVA620 0281 

If the Engine Won’t Start

Nothing Happens or the Starter Turn the ignition switch to the than normal, when you turn the
Motor Operates Very Slowly START (III) position. If the ignition switch to the START (III)
When you turn the ignition switch to headlights do not dim, check the position, but the engine does not run.
the START (III) position, you do not condition of the fuses. If the fuses Are you using a properly coded
hear the normal noise of the engine are OK, there is probably key? An improperly coded key will
trying to start. You may hear a something wrong with the cause the immobilizer system
clicking sound, a series of clicks, or electrical circuit for the ignition indicator in the instrument panel
nothing at all. switch or starter motor. You will to blink rapidly (see page 77 ).
Check these things: need a qualified technician to
determine the problem. See Are you using the proper starting
Check the transmission interlock. Emergency Towing on page 290 . procedure? Refer to Starting the
If you have a manual transmission, Engine on page 204 .
the clutch pedal must be pushed If the headlights dim noticeably or
all the way to the floor or the go out when you try to start the Do you have fuel? Check the fuel
starter will not operate. With an engine, either the battery is gauge; the low fuel indicator may
automatic transmission, it must be discharged or the connections are not be working.
in Park or neutral. corroded. Check the condition of
the battery and terminal connec- There may be an electrical
Turn the ignition switch to the ON tions (see page 265 ). You can problem, such as no power to the
(II) position. Turn on the then try jump starting the vehicle fuel pump. Check all the fuses
headlights, and check their from a booster battery (see page (see page 284 ).
brightness. If the headlights are 277 ).
very dim or do not come on at all, If you find nothing wrong, you will
the battery is discharged. See The Starter Operates Normally need a qualified technician to find
Jump Starting on page 277 . In this case, the starter motor’s the problem. See Emergency
speed sounds normal, or even faster Towing on page 290 .

276
07/07/11 15:46:56 31SVA620 0282 

Jump Starting

Although this seems like a simple To jump start your vehicle: DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L
procedure, you should take several 1. Open the hood, and check the
precautions. physical condition of the battery.
In very cold weather, check the
condition of the electrolyte. If it
seems slushy or frozen, do not try
A battery can explode if you do jump starting until it thaws.
not follow the correct procedure,
seriously injuring anyone
nearby.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, the
Keep all sparks, open flames, electrolyte inside can f reeze. BOOSTER BATTERY
and smoking materials away Attempting to jump start with a f rozen
from the battery. battery can cause it to rupture. The numbers in the illustrations
show you the order to connect the
2. Turn off all the electrical jumper cables.

Taking Care of the Unexpected


You cannot start your vehicle with an accessories: heater, A/C, audio
automatic transmission by pushing system, lights, etc. Put the
or pulling it. transmission in neutral (manual)
or Park (automatic), and set the
parking brake.

CONTINUED

277
07/07/11 15:47:04 31SVA620 0283 

Jump Starting

Si DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si

BOOSTER BATTERY

3. Connect one jumper cable to the 4. Connect the second jumper cable 6. Start the vehicle. If the starter
positive (+) terminal on your to the negative (−) terminal on motor still operates slowly, check
battery. Connect the other end to the booster battery. Connect the that the jumper cables have good
the positive (+) terminal on the other end to the grounding strap metal-to-metal contact.
booster battery. as shown. Do not connect this
jumper cable to any other part of
the engine.

5. If the booster battery is in another


vehicle, have an assistant start
that vehicle and run it at a fast idle.

278
07/07/11 15:47:13 31SVA620 0284 

Jump Starting, If the Engine Overheats

7. Once your vehicle is running, If the Engine Overheats


disconnect the negative cable from The reading of the vehicle’s
your vehicle, then from the temperature gauge should stay in Steam and spray from an
booster battery. Disconnect the the midrange. If it climbs to the red overheated engine can
positive cable from your vehicle, mark, you should determine the seriously scald you.
then from the booster battery. reason (hot day, driving up a steep
hill, etc.). Do not open the hood if steam
Keep the ends of the jumper cables is coming out.
away from each other and any metal If the vehicle overheats, you
on the vehicle until everything is should take immediate action. The
disconnected. Otherwise, you may only indication may be the 1. Safely pull to the side of the road.
cause an electrical short. temperature gauge climbing to or Put the transmission in neutral
above the red mark. Or you may (manual) or Park (automatic), and
see steam or spray coming from set the parking brake. Turn off all
under the hood. accessories, and turn on the
hazard warning indicators.

Taking Care of the Unexpected


2. If you see steam and/or spray
Driving with the temperature gauge coming from under the hood, turn
reading at the red mark can cause off the engine. Wait until you see
serious damage to the engine. no more signs of steam or spray,
then open the hood.

CONTINUED

279
07/07/11 15:47:22 31SVA620 0285 

If the Engine Overheats

3. If you do not see steam or spray, 7. If there was no coolant in the 9. Start the engine, and set the
leave the engine running and reserve tank, you may need to add temperature control dial to
watch the temperature gauge. If coolant to the radiator. Let the maximum heat. Add coolant to the
the high heat is due to overloading, engine cool down until the reading radiator up to the base of the filler
the engine should start to cool reaches the middle of the neck. If you do not have the
down almost immediately. If it temperature gauge, or lower, proper coolant mixture available,
does, wait until the temperature before checking the radiator. you can add plain water.
gauge comes down to the midpoint, Remember to have the cooling
then continue driving. system drained and refilled with
the proper mixture as soon as you
4. If the temperature gauge stays at Removing the radiator cap can.
the red mark, turn off the engine. while the engine is hot can
cause the coolant to spray out, 10. Put the radiator cap back on
5. Look for any obvious coolant leaks, seriously scalding you. tightly. Run the engine, and check
such as a split radiator hose. the temperature gauge. If it goes
Everything is still extremely hot, Always let the engine and back to the red mark, the engine
so use caution. If you find a leak, it radiator cool down before needs repair (see Emergency
must be repaired before you removing the radiator cap. Towing on page 290 ).
continue driving (see Emergency
Towing on page 290 ). 8. Using gloves or a large heavy 11. If the temperature stays normal,
cloth, turn the radiator cap check the coolant level in the
6. If you don’t find an obvious leak, counterclockwise, without pushing radiator reserve tank. If it has
check the coolant level in the down, to the first stop. After the gone down, add coolant to the
radiator reserve tank (see page pressure releases, push down on MAX mark. Put the cap back on
191 ). Add coolant if the level is the cap, and turn it until it comes tightly.
below the MIN mark. off.

280
07/07/11 15:47:31 31SVA620 0286 

Low Oil Pressure Indicator, Charging System Indicator

Low Oil Pressure Indicator 1. Safely pull off the road, and shut Charging System Indicator
This indicator should never off the engine. Turn on the hazard If the charging system
come on when the engine is warning indicators. indicator comes on brightly
running. If it starts flashing or stays when the engine is running, the
on, the oil pressure has dropped very 2. Let the vehicle sit for a minute. battery is not being charged.
low or lost pressure. Serious engine Open the hood, and check the oil
damage is possible, and you should level (see page 189 ). An engine Immediately turn off all electrical
take immediate action. very low on oil can lose pressure accessories. Try not to use other
during cornering and other driving electrically operated controls such as
maneuvers. the power windows. Keep the engine
running; starting the engine will
Running the engine with low oil 3. If necessary, add oil to bring the discharge the battery rapidly.
pressure can cause serious mechanical level back to the full mark on the
damage almost immediately. Turn of f dipstick (see page 234 ). Go to a service station or garage
the engine as soon as you can saf ely get where you can get technical
the vehicle stopped. 4. Start the engine, and watch the oil assistance.

Taking Care of the Unexpected


pressure indicator. If it does not go
out within 10 seconds, turn off the
engine. There is a mechanical
problem that needs to be repaired
before you can continue driving
(see Emergency Towing on page
290 ).

281
07/07/11 15:47:38 31SVA620 0287 

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

If the indicator comes on If the indicator comes on repeatedly, these codes are set. If they are not
while driving, it means one even though it may turn off as you set, the test cannot be completed.
of the engine’s emissions control continue driving, have your vehicle
systems may have a problem. Even checked by the dealer as soon as If the battery in your vehicle has
though you may feel no difference in possible. been disconnected or gone dead,
your vehicle’s performance, it can these codes may be erased. It can
reduce your fuel economy and cause take several days of driving under
increased emissions. Continued various conditions to set the codes
operation may cause serious damage. If you keep driving with the again.
malf unction indicator lamp on, you can
If you have recently refueled your damage your vehicle’s emissions To check if they are set, turn the
vehicle, the indicator coming on controls and engine. Those repairs may ignition switch to the ON (II)
could be due to a loose or missing not be covered by your vehicle’s position, without starting the engine.
fuel fill cap. You will also see a warranties. The malfunction indicator lamp will
‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’ message on come on for 20 seconds. If it then
the information display. Tighten the If your vehicle has an automatic goes off, the readiness codes are set.
cap until it clicks at least once. transmission, the malfunction If it blinks five times, the readiness
Tightening the cap will not turn the indicator lamp may also come on codes are not set. If possible, do not
indicator off immediately; it can take with the ‘‘D’’ indicator. take your vehicle for an emissions
several days of normal driving. test until the readiness codes are set.
Readiness Codes Refer to Emissions Testing for
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readiness more information (see page 308 ).
codes’’ that are part of the on-board
diagnostics for the emissions
systems. In some states, part of the
emissions testing is to make sure

282
07/07/11 15:47:45 31SVA620 0288 

Brake System Indicator

U.S. Canada The brake system However, if the brake pedal does not If the ABS indicator and the VSA
indicator normally feel normal, you should take system indicator (if equipped) come
comes on when immediate action. A problem in one on with the brake system indicator,
you turn the ignition switch to the part of the system’s dual circuit have your vehicle inspected by your
ON (II) position and as a reminder to design will still give you braking at dealer immediately.
check the parking brake. It will stay two wheels. You will feel the brake
on if you do not fully release the pedal go down much farther before
parking brake. the vehicle begins to slow down, and
you will have to press harder on the
If the brake system indicator comes pedal.
on while driving, the brake fluid level
is probably low. Press lightly on the Slow down by shifting to a lower
brake pedal to see if it feels normal. gear, and pull to the side of the road
If it does, check the brake fluid level when it is safe. Because of the long
the next time you stop at a service distance needed to stop, it is
station (see page 244 ). hazardous to drive the vehicle. You

Taking Care of the Unexpected


should have it towed and repaired as
If the fluid level is low, take your soon as possible (see Emergency
vehicle to a dealer, and have the Towing on page 290 ).
brake system inspected for leaks or
worn brake pads. If you must drive the vehicle a short
distance in this condition, drive
slowly and carefully.

283
07/07/11 15:47:52 31SVA620 0289 

Fuses

INTERIOR UNDER-HOOD Checking and Replacing Fuses


If something electrical in your
vehicle stops working, check for a
blown fuse first. Determine from the
chart on pages 288 and 289 , or the
diagram on the fuse box lid, which
fuse or fuses control that device.
Check those fuses first, but check all
TAB the fuses before deciding that a
blown fuse is the cause. Replace any
blown fuses, and check if the device
works.

The vehicle’s fuses are contained in The under-hood fuse box is in the
two fuse boxes. engine compartment on the driver’s
side, next to the brake fluid reservoir.
The interior fuse box is on the To open it, push the tabs as shown.
driver’s lower left side.

284
07/07/11 15:48:00 31SVA620 0290 

Fuses

FUSE BLOWN FUSE BLOWN

FUSE PULLER

1. Turn the ignition switch to the 3. Check each of the large fuses in 4. Check the smaller fuses in the
LOCK (0) position. Make sure the the under-hood fuse box by under-hood fuse box and all the
headlights and all other looking through the top at the wire fuses in the interior fuse box by

Taking Care of the Unexpected


accessories are off. inside. Removing these fuses pulling out each one with the fuse
requires a Phillips-head screw- puller provided on the back of the
2. Remove the cover from the fuse driver. under-hood fuse box cover.
box.

CONTINUED

285
07/07/11 15:48:06 31SVA620 0291 

Fuses

If you cannot drive the vehicle


BLOWN without fixing the problem, and you
do not have a spare fuse, take a fuse Replacing a f use with one that has a
of the same rating or a lower rating higher rating greatly increases the
from one of the other circuits. Make chances of damaging the electrical
sure you can do without that circuit system. If you do not have a
temporarily (such as the accessory replacement f use with the proper rating
power socket or radio). f or the circuit, install one with a lower
rating.
If you replace the blown fuse with a
spare fuse that has a lower rating, it 6. If the replacement fuse of the
might blow out again. This does not same rating blows in a short time,
indicate anything wrong. Replace the there is probably a serious
5. Look for a blown wire inside the fuse with one of the correct rating as electrical problem in your vehicle.
fuse. If it is blown, replace it with soon as you can. Leave the blown fuse in that
one of the spare fuses of the same circuit and have your vehicle
rating or lower. checked by a qualified technician.

286
07/07/11 15:48:12 31SVA620 0292 

Fuses

All models except DX


SPARE FUSES
If the driver’s power window fuse is
removed, the AUTO function of the
driver’s window will be disabled. You
should reset the AUTO feature, (see
page 101 ).

If the radio fuse is removed, the


audio system may disable itself. The
next time you turn on the radio, you
will see ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in the
FUSE PULLER frequency display. Use the preset
buttons to enter the five-digit code
Your vehicle has spare fuses on the (see page 179 ).
back of the under-hood fuse box
cover. When the audio system is disabled,

Taking Care of the Unexpected


the clock setting in the audio system
will be canceled. You will need to
reset the clock (see page 180 ).

287
07/10/30 14:08:41 31SVA620 0293 

Fuse Locations

UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX No. Amps. Circuits Protected


5 − Not Used
6 20 A Fan Motor
7 30 A Main Fan Motor (A/T)
20 A Main Fan Motor (M/T)
8 40 A Rear Defroster
9 40 A Blower
10 10 A Hazard
11 15 A FI
12 15 A Stop, Horn
13 − Not Used
14 − Not Used
15 7.5 A Oil Level Sensor
16 − Not Used
17 (15 A) Audio Amp*2
No. Amps. Circuits Protected 18 15 A Ignition Coil
1 100 A Main Fuse 19 15 A FI Main
(70 A) EPS*2 20 7.5 A MG Clutch
2 60 A Option 21 15 A DBW
50 A Ignition Switch Main 22 7.5 A Interior Light
3 30 A ABS/VSA Motor 23 10 A Back Up
30 A ABS/VSA F/S
40 A*1 *1 : Si model with VSA
4 50 A Headlight Main *2 : If equipped
40 A Power Window Main

288
07/07/12 17:24:27 31SVA620 0294 

Fuse Locations

INTERIOR FUSE BOX No. Amps. Circuits Protected


17 10 A Left Headlight Low Beam
18 20 A Headlight High Beam Main
19 15 A Small Lights Main
20 − Not Used
21 20 A Headlight Low Beam Main
22 − Not Used
23 − Not Used
24 (20 A) Moonroof *
25 20 A Door Lock
26 20 A Driver’s Power Window
27 (20 A) HAC Option
28 (15 A) Rear Accessory Socket*
29 15 A Accessory
No. Amps. Circuits Protected No. Amps. Circuits Protected 30 20 A Front Passenger’s Power
1 7.5 A Power Window 9 7.5 A ODS (Occupant Detection Window

Taking Care of the Unexpected


2 15 A Fuel Pump System) 31 − Not Used
3 10 A IG1 ACG 10 7.5 A Meter 32 − Not Used
4 7.5 A ABS/VSA 11 10 A SRS 33 − Not Used
5 (15 A) Heated Seats* 12 10 A Right Headlight High Beam 34 − Not Used
6 (20 A) Front Fog Lights* 13 10 A Left Headlight High Beam 35 7.5 A Accessory, Radio
7 7.5 A TPMS* 14 7.5 A Small Lights (Interior) 36 10 A IG2 HAC
8 − Not Used 15 7.5 A Small Lights (Exterior) 37 7.5 A Daytime Running Lights
16 10 A Right Headlight Low Beam 38 30 A Front Wiper
*: If equipped

289
07/07/11 15:48:39 31SVA620 0295 

Emergency Towing

If your vehicle needs to be towed, If, due to damage, your vehicle must
call a professional towing service or be towed with the front wheels on
organization. Never tow your vehicle the ground, do this: Improper towing preparation will
with just a rope or chain. It is very damage the transmission. Follow the
dangerous. Manual transmission: above procedure exactly. If you cannot
Release the parking brake. shif t the transmission or start the
There are two ways to tow your Shift the transmission to neutral. engine (automatic transmission), your
vehicle: Leave the ignition switch in the vehicle must be transported with the
ACCESSORY (I) position so the f ront wheels of f the ground.
Flat-bed Equipment − The operator steering wheel does not lock.
loads your vehicle on the back of a With the front wheels on the ground,
truck. This is the best way to Automatic transmission: do not tow the vehicle more than 50
transport your vehicle. Start the engine. miles (80 km), and keep the speed
Press on the brake pedal. Move below 35 mph (55 km/h).
Wheel-lift Equipment − The tow the shift lever through all its
truck uses two pivoting arms that go positions. Do not tie down the vehicle at an
under the front tires and lift them off Shift to D position for 5 seconds, angle that would allow the towing
the ground. The rear tires remain on then to N. cables to contact the vehicle’s front
the ground. This is an acceptable Turn off the engine. bumper. To avoid possible damage,
way to tow your vehicle. Release the parking brake. protect the front bumper with tape.
Leave the ignition switch in the
ACCESSORY (I) position so the If your vehicle is equipped with a
steering wheel does not lock. front spoiler, remove it before
towing so it is not damaged.

290
07/07/11 15:48:43 31SVA620 0296 

Emergency Towing

Trying to lif t or tow your vehicle by the The steering system can be damaged if
bumpers will cause serious damage. the steering wheel is locked. Leave the
The bumpers are not designed to ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I)
support the vehicle’s weight. position, and make sure the steering
wheel turns f reely bef ore you begin
towing.

Taking Care of the Unexpected


291
07/07/11 15:48:46 31SVA620 0297 

292
07/07/11 15:48:49 31SVA620 0298 

Technical Information

The diagrams in this section give Identification Numbers ................. 294 Emissions Controls........................ 305
you the dimensions and capacities of Specifications ................................. 296 The Clean Air Act ...................... 305
your vehicle and the locations of the DOT Tire Quality Grading Crankcase Emissions Control
identification numbers. It also (U.S. Vehicles) ....................... 299 System..................................... 305
includes information you should Uniform Tire Quality Evaporative Emissions Control
know about your vehicle’s tires and Grading ................................... 299 System..................................... 305
emissions control systems. Treadwear .................................. 299 Onboard Refueling Vapor
Traction....................................... 299 Recovery ................................. 305
Temperature .............................. 300 Exhaust Emissions Controls .... 306
Tire Labeling .................................. 301 PGM-FI System ..................... 306
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Ignition Timing Control
(TPMS) − Required Federal System................................. 306
Explanation............................. 303 Exhaust Gas Recirculation
(EGR)System ..................... 306
Three Way Catalytic
Converter ............................ 306
Replacement Parts..................... 306
Three Way Catalytic Converter ... 307

Technical Information
Emissions Testing ......................... 308

293
07/07/11 15:48:54 31SVA620 0299 

Identification Numbers

Your vehicle has several identifying


numbers located in various places.

The vehicle identification number LID


(VIN) is the 17-digit number your VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
dealer uses to register your vehicle
for warranty purposes. It is also
necessary for licensing and insuring
your vehicle. The easiest place to
find the VIN is on a plate fastened to
the top of the dashboard. You can
see it by looking through the
windshield on the driver’s side. It is
also on the certification label
attached to the driver’s doorjamb,
and is stamped on the engine
compartment bulkhead. The VIN is
also provided in bar code on the
certification label.

To access the VIN in the engine


compartment, slide the lid on the
back of the engine compartment.
Make sure to close the lid before
closing the hood. CERTIFICATION LABEL

294
07/07/11 19:57:25 31SVA620 0300 

Identification Numbers

The engine number is stamped into DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, and EX-L
the engine block. It is on the front.

The transmission number is on a


label on top of the transmission. ENGINE NUMBER

AUTOMATIC/MANUAL
TRANSMISSION NUMBER

Si

ENGINE NUMBER

Technical Information
MANUAL TRANSMISSION
NUMBER

295
07/10/30 14:08:58 31SVA620 0301 

Specifications

Dimensions Engine
Length 174.8 in (4,440 mm) Type Water cooled 4-stroke
Width 68.9 in (1,751 mm) SOHC VTEC*1, DOHC i-VTEC*2
Height 53.5 in (1,358 mm) 4-cylinder gasoline engine
Wheelbase 104.3 in (2,650 mm) Bore x Stroke 3.19 x 3.44 in (81.0 x 87.3 mm)*1
Track Front 59.0 in (1,499 mm) 3.39 x 3.39 in (86 x 86 mm)*2
Rear 59.9 in (1,522 mm) *1 Displacement 110 cu-in (1,799 cm ) *1
60.2 in (1,528 mm) *2 122 cu-in (1,998 cm ) *2
Compression ratio 10.5 *1
*1 : LX, Canadian DX-G (M/T), EX, EX-L 11.0 *2
*2 : DX, Canadian DX-G (A/T) Spark plugs*1 NGK: IZFR6K-11S
DENSO: SKJ20DR-M11S
Seating Capacities Spark plugs*2 NGK: IFR7G-11KS
Total 5 DENSO: SK22PR-M11S
Front 2
Rear 3 *1 : DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L
*2 : Si
Weights
Gross vehicle weight rating See the certification label attached
to the driver’s doorjamb.

296
07/07/11 15:49:37 31SVA620 0302 

Specifications

Capacities Air Conditioning


Fuel tank Approx. 13.2 US gal (50 ) Refrigerant type HFC-134a (R-134a)
Engine Change*1 A/T 1.45 US gal (5.5 )*3 Charge quantity 14.1−15.9 oz (400−450 g)
coolant M/T 1.37 US gal (5.2 )*3 Lubricant oil type SP-10
1.19 US gal (4.5 )*4
Total A/T 1.88 US gal (7.1 )*3 Lights
M/T 1.72 US gal (6.5 )*3 Headlights (HI) 12 V − 60 W (HB3)
1.80 US gal (6.8 )*4 Headlights (LO) 12 V − 51 W (HB4)
Engine oil Change*2 Front turn signal/Side marker/ 12 V − 28/8 W
Including 3.9 US qt (3.7 )*3 Parking light
filter 4.6 US qt (4.4 )*4 Rear turn signal lights 12 V − 21 W
Without filter 3.7 US qt (3.5 )*3 Stop/Taillights 12 V − 21/5 W
4.4 US qt (4.2 )*4 Rear side marker lights 12 V − 3 CP
Total 4.8 US qt (4.5 )*3 Back-up lights 12 V − 18 W
5.8 US qt (5.5 )*4 High-mount brake light* 12 V − 21 W
Manual Change 1.5 US qt (1.4 )*3 License plate lights 12 V − 3 CP
transmission 1.6 US qt (1.5 )*4 Ceiling light 12 V − 8 W
fluid Total 1.7 US qt (1.6 )*3 Spotlights 12 V − 8 W
1.8 US qt (1.7 )*4 Trunk light 12 V − 5 W
Automatic Change 2.5 US qt (2.4 ) * : U.S. DX and LX

Technical Information
transmission Total 6.2 US qt (5.9 ) Canada: DX, DX-G, LX
fluid EX, EX-L, Si: Replacement of the light should be done by your
Windshield U.S. Vehicles 2.6 US qt (2.5 ) dealer.
washer Canada 4.8 US qt (4.5 )
reservoir Vehicles
*1 : Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in
the engine
Reserve tank capacity: 0.11 US gal (0.4 )
*2 : Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
*3 : U.S.: DX, LX, EX, EX-L Canada: DX, DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L
*4 : Si

297
07/10/30 14:12:08 31SVA620 0303 

Specifications

Battery Tires
Capacity 12 V − 36 AH/5 HR *1 Size Front/Rear P195/65R15 89H *1
12 V − 38 AH/5 HR *2, *3 P195/65R15 89S *2
12 V − 45 AH/20 HR *1 P205/55R16 89H *3
12 V − 47 AH/20 HR *2, *3 P215/45R17 87V *4
215/45ZR17 91W *5
*1 : U.S.: DX, LX, EX, EX-L Spare T125/70D15 95M *6
*2 : Canada: DX, DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L T135/80R16 101M *7
*3 : Si T125/70D16 96M *8
Pressure Front/Rear 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
Fuses Spare 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Interior See page 289 or the fuse label
attached to the dashboard. *1 : U.S.: DX
Under-hood See page 288 or the fuse box Canada: DX, DX-G with automatic transmission
cover. *2 : Canada: DX-G with manual transmission
*3 : LX, EX, EX-L
Alignment *4 : Si (all season tires)
Toe-in Front 0.00 in (0.0 mm) *5 : Optional for Si (summer tires)
Rear 0.08 in (2.0 mm) *6 : U.S.: DX, LX, EX, EX-L Canada: DX, DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L
Camber Front 0° *7 : U.S.: Si Canada: Si with VSA
Rear −0°45’ *1 *8 : Canada: Si without VSA
−1°30’ *2
Caster Front 7°

*1 : LX, Canadian DX-G (M/T), EX, EX-L


*2 : DX, Canadian DX-G (A/T)

298
07/07/11 15:50:01 31SVA620 0304 

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)

The tires on your vehicle meet all Treadwear Traction


U.S. Federal Safety Requirements. The treadwear grade is a compara- The traction grades, from highest to
All tires are also graded for tive rating based on the wear rate of lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those
treadwear, traction, and temperature the tire when tested under controlled grades represent the tire’s ability to
performance according to conditions on a specified government stop on wet pavement as measured
Department of Transportation test course. For example, a tire under controlled conditions on
(DOT) standards. The following graded 150 would wear one and one- specified government test surfaces
explains these gradings. half (1 1/2) times as well on the of asphalt and concrete. A tire
government course as a tire graded marked C may have poor traction
Uniform Tire Quality Grading 100. The relative performance of performance.
Quality grades can be found where tires depends upon the actual condi-
applicable on the tire sidewall tions of their use, however, and may Warning: The traction grade
between tread shoulder and depart significantly from the norm assigned to this tire is based on
maximum section width. For due to variations in driving habits, straight-ahead braking traction tests,
example: service practices and differences in and does not include acceleration,
Treadwear 200 road characteristics and climate. cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
Traction AA traction characteristics.
Temperature A

Technical Information
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.

299
07/07/11 15:50:05 31SVA620 0305 

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)

Temperature Warning: The temperature grade for


The temperature grades are A (the this tire is established for a tire that
highest), B, and C, representing the is properly inflated and not
tire’s resistance to the generation of overloaded. Excessive speed,
heat and its ability to dissipate heat underinflation, or excessive loading,
when tested under controlled either separately or in combination,
conditions on a specified indoor can cause heat buildup and possible
laboratory test wheel. Sustained high tire failure.
temperature can cause the material
of the tire to degenerate and reduce
tire life, and excessive temperature
can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of
performance which all passenger car
tires must meet under the Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No.
109. Grades B and A represent
higher levels of performance on the
laboratory test wheel than the
minimum required by law.

300
07/07/11 15:50:21 31SVA620 0306 

Tire Labeling

The tires that came on your vehicle Tire Size 89 − Load index (a numerical code
have a number of markings. Those Whenever tires are replaced, they associated with the maximum
you should be aware of are described should be replaced with tires of the load the tire can carry).
below. same size. Following is an example
of tire size with an explanation of H − Speed symbol (an
Tire Labeling Example what each component means. alphabetical code indicating
(1) the maximum speed rating).
P205/55R16 89H
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
P − Vehicle type (P indicates The tire identification number (TIN)
passenger vehicle). is a group of numbers and letters
that look like the following example.
205 − Tire width in millimeters. TIN is located on the sidewall of the
tire.
55 − Aspect ratio (the tire’s section
height as a percentage of its DOT B97R FW6X 2202
width).
DOT − This indicates that the tire

Technical Information
(4) (1) R − Tire construction code (R meets all requirements of
indicates radial). the U.S. Department of
(3) (2) Transportation.
16 − Rim diameter in inches.
(1) Tire Size B97R − Manufacturer’s
(2) Tire Identification Number (TIN) identification mark.
(3) Maximum Tire Pressure
(4) Maximum Tire Load CONTINUED

301
07/07/11 15:50:28 31SVA620 0307 

Tire Labeling

FW6X − Tire type code.

2202 − Date of manufacture.


Year
Week

Maximum Tire Pressure


Max Press − The maximum air
pressure the tire can
hold.

Maximum Tire Load


Max Load − The maximum load the
tire can carry at
maximum air pressure.

302
07/10/30 14:11:53 31SVA620 0308 

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) − Required Federal Explanation

U.S. models only As an added safety feature, your Driving on a significantly under-
Each tire, including the spare (if vehicle has been equipped with a tire inflated tire causes the tire to
provided), should be checked pressure monitoring system (TPMS) overheat and can lead to tire failure.
monthly when cold and inflated to that illuminates a low tire pressure Under-inflation also reduces fuel
the inflation pressure recommended telltale efficiency and tire tread life, and may
by the vehicle manufacturer on the affect the vehicle’s handling and
vehicle placard or tire inflation stopping ability.
pressure label.
when one or more of your tires is Please note that the TPMS is not a
(If your vehicle has tires of a significantly under-inflated. substitute for proper tire
different size than the size indicated maintenance, and it is the driver’s
on the vehicle placard or tire Accordingly, when the low tire responsibility to maintain correct tire
inflation pressure label, you should pressure telltale illuminates, you pressure, even if under-inflation has
determine the proper tire inflation should stop and check your tires as not reached the level to trigger
pressure for those tires.) soon as possible, and inflate them to illumination of the TPMS low tire
the proper pressure. pressure telltale.

Technical Information
CONTINUED

303
07/07/11 15:50:41 31SVA620 0309 

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) − Required Federal Explanation

Your vehicle has also been equipped Always check the TPMS malfunction
with a TPMS malfunction indicator telltale after replacing one or more
to indicate when the system is not tires or wheels on your vehicle to
operating properly. The TPMS ensure that the replacement or
malfunction indicator is provided by alternate tires and wheels allow the
a separate telltale, which displays the TPMS to continue to function
symbol ‘‘TPMS’’ when illuminated. properly.

When the malfunction indicator is


illuminated,

the system may not be able to detect


or signal low tire pressure as
intended.

TPMS malfunctions may occur for a


variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from
functioning properly.

304
07/07/11 15:50:48 31SVA620 0310 

Emissions Controls

The burning of gasoline in your The Clean Air Act intake manifold. They are then
vehicle’s engine produces several by- The United States Clean Air Act* drawn into the engine and burned.
products. Some of these are carbon sets standards for automobile
monoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen emissions. It also requires that Evaporative Emissions Control
(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC). automobile manufacturers explain to System
Gasoline evaporating from the tank owners how their emissions controls As gasoline evaporates in the fuel
also produces hydrocarbons. Con- work and what to do to maintain tank, an evaporative emissions
trolling the production of NOx, CO, them. This section summarizes how control canister filled with charcoal
and HC is important to the environ- the emissions controls work. adsorbs the vapor. It is stored in this
ment. Under certain conditions of canister while the engine is off. After

sunlight and climate, NOx and HC In Canada, Honda vehicles comply the engine is started and warmed up,
react to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’ with the Canadian emission the vapor is drawn into the engine
Carbon monoxide does not contri- requirements, as specified in an and burned during driving.
bute to smog creation, but it is a agreement with Environment
poisonous gas. Canada, at the time they are Onboard Refueling Vapor
manufactured. Recovery
The onboard refueling vapor
Crankcase Emissions Control recovery (ORVR) system captures

Technical Information
System the fuel vapors during refueling. The
Your vehicle has a positive vapors are adsorbed in a canister
crankcase ventilation system. This filled with activated carbon. While
keeps gasses that build up in the driving, the fuel vapors are drawn
engine’s crankcase from going into into the engine and burned off.
the atmosphere. The positive
crankcase ventilation valve routes
them from the crankcase back to the

305
07/07/11 15:50:58 31SVA620 0311 

Emissions Controls

Exhaust Emissions Controls much air is going into the engine. It Three Way Catalytic Converter
The exhaust emissions controls then controls how much fuel to inject The three way catalytic converter is
include three or four systems: under all operating conditions. in the exhaust system. Through
PGM-FI, ignition timing control, chemical reactions, it converts HC,
exhaust gas recirculation (DX, LX, Ignition Timing Control System CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaust
EX and EX-L), and three way This system constantly adjusts the to carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrogen
catalytic converter. These systems ignition timing, reducing the amount (N2), and water vapor.
work together to control the engine’s of HC, CO, and NOx produced.
combustion and minimize the Replacement Parts
amount of HC, CO, and NOx that Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) The emissions control systems are
comes out the tailpipe. The exhaust System designed and certified to work to-
emissions control systems are On DX, LX, EX and EX-L models gether in reducing emissions to
separate from the crankcase and The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) levels that comply with the Clean Air
evaporative emissions control system takes some of the exhaust Act. To make sure the emissions
systems. gas and routes it back into the intake remain low, you should use only new
manifold. Adding exhaust gas to the Honda replacement parts or their
PGM-FI System air/fuel mixture reduces the amount equivalent for repairs. Using lower
The PGM-FI system uses sequential of NOx produced when the fuel is quality parts may increase the
multiport fuel injection. It has three burned. emissions from your vehicle.
subsystems: air intake, engine
control, and fuel control. The The emissions control systems are
powertrain control module (PCM) in covered by warranties separate from
automatic transmission vehicles or the rest of your vehicle. Read your
the engine control module (ECM) in warranty manual for more informa-
manual transmission vehicles uses tion.
various sensors to determine how

306
07/07/11 15:51:06 31SVA620 0312 

Three Way Catalytic Converter

DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L Si model Always use unleaded gasoline.
Even a small amount of leaded
gasoline can contaminate the
catalyst metals, making the three
way catalytic converter ineffective.

Keep the engine well maintained.

Have your vehicle diagnosed and


repaired if it is misfiring, back-
firing, stalling, or otherwise not
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER running properly.

The three way catalytic converter for the chemical reactions to take
contains precious metals that serve place. It can set on fire any
as catalysts, promoting chemical combustible materials that come
reactions to convert the exhaust near it. Park your vehicle away from
gasses without affecting the metals. high grass, dry leaves, or other

Technical Information
The catalytic converter is referred to flammables.
as a three-way catalyst, since it acts
on HC, CO, and NOx. A replacement A defective three way catalytic
unit must be an original Honda part converter contributes to air pollution,
or its equivalent. and can impair your engine’s per-
formance. Follow these guidelines to
The three way catalytic converter protect your vehicle’s three way
must operate at a high temperature catalytic converter.

307
07/07/11 15:51:14 31SVA620 0313 

Emissions Testing

Testing of Readiness Codes If the testing facility determines that 4. Without touching the accelerator
If you take your vehicle for an the readiness codes are not set, you pedal, start the engine, and let it
emissions test shortly after the will be requested to return at a later idle for 20 seconds.
battery has been disconnected or date to complete the test. If you must
gone dead, it may not pass the test. get the vehicle retested within the 5. Keep the vehicle in Park
This is because of certain ‘‘readiness next two or three days, you can (automatic transmission) or
codes’’ that must be set in the on- condition the vehicle for retesting by neutral (manual transmission).
board diagnostics for the emissions doing the following. Increase the engine speed to 2,000
systems. These codes are erased rpm, and hold it there until the
when the battery is disconnected, 1. Make sure the gas tank is nearly, temperature gauge rises to at least
and set again only after several days but not completely, full (around 1/4 of the scale (about 3 minutes).
of driving under a variety of 3/4).
conditions. 6. Without touching the accelerator
2. Make sure the vehicle has been pedal, let the engine idle for 20
parked with the engine off for 6 seconds.
hours or more.

3. Make sure the ambient


temperature is between 40° and
95°F.

308
07/07/11 15:51:19 31SVA620 0314 

Emissions Testing

7. Select a nearby lightly traveled 8. Then drive in city/suburban


major highway where you can traffic for at least 10 minutes.
maintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph When traffic conditions allow, let
(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 the vehicle coast for several
minutes. Drive on the highway in seconds without using the
D (automatic) or 5th (manual). Do accelerator pedal or the brake
not use the cruise control. When pedal.
traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds
without moving the accelerator 9. Make sure the vehicle has been
pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary parked with the engine off for 30
slightly; this is okay.) If you cannot minutes.
do this for a continuous 90
seconds because of traffic If the testing facility determines the
conditions, drive for at least 30 readiness codes are still not set, see
seconds, then repeat it two more your dealer.
times (for a total of 90 seconds).

Technical Information
309
07/07/11 15:51:21 31SVA620 0315 

310
07/07/11 15:51:24 31SVA620 0316 

Warranty and Customer Relations

Customer Service Information..... 312


Warranty Coverages ..................... 313
Reporting Safety Defects
(U.S. Vehicles) ........................... 314
Authorized Manuals ...................... 315

Warranty and Customer Relations


311
07/07/11 15:51:31 31SVA620 0317 

Customer Service Information

Honda dealership personnel are Canadian Owners: When you call or write, please give
trained professionals. They should Customer Relations us this information:
be able to answer all your questions. Honda Canada Inc.
If you encounter a problem that your 715 Milner Avenue Vehicle identification number (see
dealership does not solve to your Toronto, ON page 294 )
satisfaction, please discuss it with M1B 2K8
the dealership’s management. The Name and address of the dealer
service manager or general manager Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9 who services your vehicle
can help. Almost all problems are Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909
solved in this way. Toronto (416) 287-4776 Date of purchase

If you are dissatisfied with the In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Mileage on your vehicle
decision made by the dealership’s Islands:
management, contact your Honda Bella International Your name, address, and
Customer Service Office. P.O. Box 190816 telephone number
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
U.S. Owners: A detailed description of the
American Honda Motor Co., Inc. Tel: (787) 620-7546 problem
Automobile Customer Service
Mail Stop 500-2N-7A Name of the dealer who sold the
1919 Torrance Boulevard vehicle to you
Torrance, California 90501-2746

Tel: (800) 999-1009

312
07/07/11 15:51:42 31SVA620 0318 

Warranty Coverages

U.S. Owners Seat Belt Limited Warranty − a seat Replacement Battery Limited
Your new vehicle is covered by these belt that fails to function properly is Warranty − provides prorated
warranties: covered by a limited warranty. coverage for a replacement battery
Please read your warranty booklet purchased from your dealer.
New Vehicle Limited Warranty − for details.

Warranty and Customer Relations


covers your new vehicle, except for Replacement Muffler Lifetime
the battery, emissions control Rust Perforation Limited Warranty Limited Warranty − provides
systems, and accessories against − all exterior body panels are coverage for as long as the pur-
defects in materials and covered for rust-through from the chaser of the muffler owns the
workmanship. inside for the specified time period vehicle.
with no mileage limit.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Restrictions and exclusions apply to
Warranty and Emissions Accessory Limited Warranty − all these warranties. Please read the
Performance Warranty − these two Honda accessories are covered 2008 Honda warranty information
warranties cover your vehicle’s under this warranty. Time and booklet that came with your vehicle
emissions control systems. Time, mileage limits depend on the type of for precise information on warranty
mileage, and coverage are accessory and other factors. Please coverages. Your vehicle’s original
conditional. Please read your read your warranty booklet for tires are covered by their
warranty booklet for exact details. manufacturer. Tire warranty
information. information is in a separate booklet.
Replacement Parts Limited
Original Equipment Battery Limited Warranty − covers all Honda Canadian Owners
Warranty − this warranty gives up replacement parts against defects in Please refer to the 2008 warranty
to 100 % credit toward a replacement materials and workmanship. manual that came with your vehicle.
battery.

313
07/10/30 17:55:59 31SVA620 0319 

Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)

If you believe that your vehicle has a If NHTSA receives similar com- To contact NHTSA, you may call the
defect which could cause a crash or plaints, it may open an investigation, Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
could cause injury or death, you and if it finds that a safety defect 1-888-327-4236
should immediately inform the exists in a group of vehicles, it may (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to
National Highway Traffic Safety order a recall and remedy campaign. http://www.saf ercar.gov; or write to:
Administration (NHTSA) in addition However, NHTSA cannot become Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New
to notifying American Honda Motor involved in individual problems Jersey Avenue, SE., Washington, DC
Co., Inc. between you, your dealer, or 20590.
American Honda Motor Co., Inc. You can also obtain other
information about motor vehicle
safety from http://www.saf ercar.gov.

314
07/10/30 14:12:19 31SVA620 0320 

Authorized Manuals

Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) Service Manual:


The publications shown below can be purchased from Helm Covers maintenance and recommended procedures for
Incorporated. You can order by phone or online: repair to engine and chassis components. It is written
Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only) for the journeyman mechanic, but it is simple enough
Go online at www. helminc. com for most mechanically inclined owners to understand.
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.
at 1-800-782-4356. Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Complements the Service Manual by providing in-depth
Publication Form Description troubleshooting information for each electrical circuit
Form Number in your vehicle.
61SNA05 2008 Honda Civic 2/4 door Service Manual
61SNA05EL 2006-2008 Honda Civic 2/4 door Body Repair Manual:

Authorized Manuals
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual Describes the procedures involved in the replacement
61SNA30 2006-2008 Model Series Honda Civic 2/4 door of damaged body parts.
Body Repair Manual
31SVA621 2008 Honda Civic 2-door Owner’s Manual
31SNA810 2008 Honda Civic Navigation System Manual
31SNAM20 2008 Honda Civic Honda Service History
31SVAQ20 2008 Honda Civic 2-door Quick Start Guide
HON-R Order Form for Previous Years
Indicate Year and Model Desired

315
07/07/11 15:51:58 31SVA620 0321 

316
07/07/11 15:52:04 31SVA620 0322 

Index

A Automatic Transmission............... 208 Parking ........................................ 105


Capacity, Fluid ........................... 297 System Design ........................... 213
Accessories and Modifications .... 195 Checking Fluid Level ................ 242 System Indicator .................. 58, 283
ACCESSORY (Ignition Key Shifting ........................................ 208 Wear Indicators ......................... 213
Position) ........................................ 78 Shift Lever Position Braking System.............................. 213
Accessory Power Sockets............. 108 Indicators ................................ 208 Break-in, New Vehicle .................. 186
Adding Engine Coolant ................. 238 Shift Lever Positions ................. 209 Brightness Control, Instruments ... 73
Additives, Engine Oil..................... 235 Shift Lock Release ..................... 211 Brights, Headlights ......................... 72
Adjusting the Steering Wheel ........ 75 Bulb Replacement
Advice for Pregnant Women .......... 16 B Back-up Lights ........................... 250
Airbag (SRS) ................................ 9, 21 Brake Lights............................... 250
Air Conditioning System ............... 114 Battery Front Parking Lights ................. 249
Usage .......................................... 117 Charging System Front Side Marker Lights......... 249
Air Pressure, Tires ................ 255, 257 Indicator............................ 57, 281 Headlights .................................. 246
Alcohol in Gasoline ........................ 187 Jump Starting ............................. 277 High-mount Brake Light .......... 251
Antifreeze ....................................... 238 Maintenance ............................... 265 Specifications ............................. 297
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) Specifications ............................. 298 Turn Signal Lights ..................... 249
Indicator ................................ 59, 214 Before Driving ............................... 185 Bulbs, Halogen ............................... 246
Operation .................................... 214 Belts, Seat ..................................... 8, 18
Anti-theft, Audio System............... 179 Beverage Holders .......................... 107 C
Anti-theft Steering Column Booster Seats ................................... 47
Lock ............................................... 78 Brakes Capacities Chart............................. 297
Audio System ................................. 119 Anti-lock System (ABS) ............ 214 Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 50

INDEX
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ...... 81 Break-in, New Linings .............. 186 Carrying Cargo .............................. 197
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners .... 19 Bulb Replacement ..................... 250
Automatic Speed Control.............. 182 Fluid ............................................ 244 CONTINUED

I
07/07/11 15:52:08 31SVA620 0323 

Index

CAUTION, Explanation of ............... ii Tethers.......................................... 45 Cruise Control Indicator ................. 62


CD Care .......................................... 174 Warning Labels ............................ 51 Cruise Control Operation ............. 182
CD Changer ........................... 135, 157 Where Should a Child Sit? .......... 33 Cup Holders.................................... 107
CD Changer Error Messages ...... 137 Child Seats Customer Service Information..... 312
CD Player ............................... 130, 150 Installing ....................................... 40
CD Player Error Messages .. 136, 158 Lower Anchors ............................ 41 D
Ceiling Light ................................... 111 Selecting ....................................... 39
Certification Label ......................... 294 Tether Anchor Points ................. 45 DANGER, Explanation of ................. ii
Chains, Tires .................................. 263 Cleaning Dashboard .................................... 3, 54
Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 271 Seat Belts .................................... 251 Daytime Running Lights................. 73
Changing Oil Clock ............................................... 180 Daytime Running Lights
How to ......................................... 236 Clutch Fluid .................................... 245 Indicator ........................................ 63
When to....................................... 225 CO in the Exhaust ......................... 305 Dead Battery .................................. 277
Charging System Indicator .... 57, 281 Coat Hook ....................................... 108 Defects, Reporting Safety............. 314
Check Fuel Cap Message ............... 68 Cold Weather, Starting in ............. 204 Defogger, Rear Window ................. 74
Checklist, Before Driving ............. 203 Compact Spare Tire....................... 270 Defrosting the Windows ............... 118
Child Safety ...................................... 32 Console Compartment .................. 107 Dimensions ..................................... 296
Booster Seats ............................... 47 Consumer Information.................. 312 Dimming the Headlights ................ 72
Child Seats .................................... 39 Controls, Instruments and .............. 53 Dipstick
Important Safety Coolant Automatic Transmission........... 242
Reminders .......................... 32, 35 Adding ......................................... 238 Engine Oil ................................... 189
Infants ........................................... 37 Checking ..................................... 191 Directional Signals ........................... 72
Large Children ............................. 46 Proper Solution .......................... 238 Disc Brake Wear Indicators ......... 213
LATCH.......................................... 41 Temperature Gauge .................... 68 Disc Care ........................................ 174
Risks with Airbags....................... 33 Crankcase Emissions Control Disc Player ............................. 130, 150
Small Children.............................. 38 System......................................... 305 Display Change Button ................... 66

II
07/07/11 15:52:14 31SVA620 0324 

Index

Disposal of Used Oil ...................... 238 Overheated Engine ................... 279 Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat
Doors Towing ........................................ 290 Belts by ......................................... 16
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.. 81 Emergency Brake .......................... 105
Locking and Unlocking ............... 79 Emergency Flashers ....................... 74 F
Power Door Locks ....................... 80 Emergency Towing ....................... 290
DOT Tire Quality Grading* ......... 299 Emergency Trunk Opener ............. 91 Fan Control..................................... 115
Downshifting, Manual Emissions Controls........................ 305 Features .......................................... 113
Transmission .............................. 205 Emissions Testing ......................... 308 Filling the Fuel Tank ..................... 187
Driver and Passenger Safety ............ 5 Engine Filters
Driving ............................................ 201 Adding Engine Coolant ............. 238 Dust and Pollen .......................... 253
Economy ..................................... 192 Coolant Temperature Gauge ..... 68 Oil ................................................ 236
Dust and Pollen Filter ................... 253 If It Won’t Start .......................... 275 Flashers, Hazard Warning.............. 74
Malfunction Indicator Flat Tire, Changing a .................... 271
E Lamp ................................. 57, 282 Fluids
Oil Life Indicator........................ 225 Automatic Transmission........... 242
Economy, Fuel ............................... 192 Oil Pressure Indicator ......... 57, 281 Brake ........................................... 244
Emergencies................................... 269 Oil, Synthetic .............................. 235 Clutch .......................................... 245
Battery, Jump Starting .............. 277 Oil, What Kind to Use ............... 234 Manual Transmission ............... 243
Brake System Indicator ............ 283 Overheating................................ 279 Power Steering........................... 245
Changing a Flat Tire ................. 271 Specifications ............................. 296 Windshield Washer ................... 241
Charging System Indicator ...... 281 Speed Limiter ..................... 207, 210 FM Stereo Radio
Checking the Fuses................... 284 Starting........................................ 204 Reception .................................... 172
Hazard Warning Flashers .......... 74 Ethanol in Gasoline ....................... 187 Folding Rear Seat ............................ 98

INDEX
Jump Starting ............................. 277 Evaporative Emissions Controls .. 305 Four-way Flashers ........................... 74
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ...... 281 Exhaust Fumes ................................ 50
Malfunction Indicator Lamp .... 282 CONTINUED

III
07/07/11 15:52:20 31SVA620 0325 

Index

Front Airbags ............................... 9, 23 Gauges High Altitude, Starting at .............. 204


Front Seat Engine Coolant Temperature .... 68 High Beam Lever............................. 72
Adjusting ....................................... 92 Fuel ................................................ 68 High-mount Brake Light............... 251
Airbags ...................................... 9, 23 Gearshift Lever Positions Hood, Opening and Closing the ... 188
Fuel .................................................. 186 Automatic Transmission........... 208 Horn............................................... 4, 70
Check Fuel Cap Message ........... 68 Manual Transmission ............... 206 Hydraulic Clutch ............................ 244
Economy ..................................... 192 Glove Box ....................................... 107
Fill Door and Cap....................... 187 Gross Axle Weight Rating I
Gauge ............................................ 68 (GAWR) ...................................... 199
Low Fuel Indicator ...................... 64 Gross Vehicle Weight Rating Identification Number, Vehicle.... 294
Octane Requirement ................. 186 (GVWR) ...................................... 199 If the Engine Overheats ............... 279
Oxygenated ................................ 187 If the Engine Wont Start ............... 275
Tank, Refueling ......................... 187 H Ignition
Fuse Locations ............................... 288 Keys............................................... 76
Fuses, Checking the ...................... 284 Halogen Headlight Bulbs.............. 246 Switch ............................................ 78
Hazard Warning Flashers............... 74 Timing Control System ............. 306
G Headlights Immobilizer System......................... 77
Aiming ......................................... 246 Important Safety Precautions .......... 6
Gas Mileage, Improving................ 192 Daytime Running Lights............. 73 Indicators
Gasoline .......................................... 186 High Beam Indicator ................... 63 ABS (Anti-Lock Brake)............... 59
Gauge ............................................ 68 Reminder Beeper ......................... 72 Brake (Parking and Brake
Low Fuel Indicator ...................... 64 Replacing Halogen Bulbs ......... 246 System) ..................................... 58
Octane Requirement ................. 186 Turning on .................................... 72 Charging System ................. 57, 281
Tank, Refueling ......................... 187 Head Restraints ............................... 95 Cruise Control .............................. 62
Gas Station Procedures................. 187 Heated Mirrors .............................. 105 DRL (Daytime Running
Heating and Cooling ...................... 114 Lights)....................................... 63

IV
07/07/11 15:52:26 31SVA620 0326 

Index

Indicators Information Display ......................... 65 Lights


EPS ................................................ 60 Inside Mirror .................................. 104 Bulb Replacement ..................... 246
High Beam.................................... 63 Inspection, Tire .............................. 258 Indicators ................................ 55, 57
Key (Immobilizer System) ......... 59 Installing a Child Seat ..................... 40 Parking .......................................... 72
Lights ON ..................................... 63 Instrument Panel ......................... 3, 54 Turn Signal ................................... 72
Low Fuel ....................................... 64 Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 73 Load Limits..................................... 198
Low Oil Pressure ................. 57, 281 Instrument and Controls................. 53 LOCK (Ignition Key Position) ....... 78
Low Tire Pressure ............... 61, 218 Interior Lights ................................ 111 Locks
Maintenance Minder........... 60, 225 Introduction ......................................... i Anti-theft Steering Column ........ 78
Malfunction Lamp ..................... 282 Fuel Fill Door ............................. 187
REV Limit ..................................... 61 J Power Door .................................. 80
Security System ........................... 64 Trunk ............................................ 90
Side Airbag Off ............................ 58 Jacking up the Vehicle .................. 272 Low Coolant Level ......................... 191
SRS ................................................ 58 Jack, Tire ........................................ 271 Low Fuel Indicator .......................... 64
TPMS .................................... 61, 219 Jump Starting ................................. 277 Low Oil Pressure Indicator .... 57, 281
Trunk Open .................................. 63 Lower Anchors................................. 41
Turn Signal and Hazard K Lower Gear, Downshifting to a.... 205
Warning .................................... 59 Lubricant Specifications Chart .... 297
Washer Level ............................... 63 Keys ................................................... 76 Luggage, Storing (Cargo) ............ 197
Indicators, Instrument
Panel ........................................ 55, 57 L
Infant Restraint ................................ 37
Infant Seats Label, Certification ........................ 294

INDEX
Installing ....................................... 40 Lane Change, Signaling .................. 72
Tether Anchor Points ................. 45 Lap/Shoulder Belts ................... 14, 19
Inflation, Proper Tire .................... 255 LATCH System ................................ 41 CONTINUED

V
07/07/11 15:52:32 31SVA620 0327 

Index

M Normal Shift Speeds...................... 206 P


NOTICE, Explanation of .................... i
Maintenance ................................... 223 Numbers, Identification ................ 294 Panel Brightness Control ............... 73
Items ................................... 228, 231 Park Gear Position......................... 209
Minder......................................... 225 O Parking ............................................ 212
Minder Indicator .................. 60, 225 Parking Brake ................................ 105
Owner’s Maintenance Octane Requirement, Gasoline .... 186 Parking Brake and Brake
Checks .................................... 230 Odometer .......................................... 66 System Indicator .................. 58, 283
Safety........................................... 224 Odometer, Trip ................................ 66 Parking Lights ......................... 72, 249
Malfunction Indicator Lamp .. 57, 282 Oil Parking Over Things that
Manual Transmission.................... 205 Change, How to ......................... 236 Burn..................................... 212, 307
Checking Fluid Level ................ 243 Change, When to ....................... 225 PC Card ........................................... 159
Shifting ........................................ 205 Checking Engine ....................... 189 PC Card Error Messages.............. 171
Manual Transmission Fluid ......... 243 Pressure Indicator ............... 57, 281 PGM-FI System.............................. 306
Mats, Floor ..................................... 252 Selecting Proper Viscosity Playing a Disc ......................... 130, 150
Meters, Gauges ................................ 65 Chart ....................................... 235 Playing a PC Card .......................... 159
Methanol in Gasoline .................... 187 ON (Ignition Key Position) ............ 78 Pollen Filter .................................... 253
Mirrors, Adjusting ......................... 104 Onboard Refueling Vapor Power Door Locks ........................... 80
Modifying Your Vehicle................ 196 Recovery ..................................... 305 Power Socket Locations ....... 106, 108
Moonroof ........................................ 102 Outside Mirrors ............................. 104 Power Steering Fluid..................... 245
MP3 ................................. 131, 151, 160 Overheating, Engine ..................... 279 Power Windows ............................. 100
Owner’s Maintenance Checks ..... 230 Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts .......... 16
N Oxygenated Fuels.......................... 187 Preparing to Drive ......................... 203
Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11
Neutral Gear Position.................... 209 Additional Safety Precautions .... 16
New Vehicle Break-in ................... 186 Advice for Pregnant Women...... 16

VI
07/07/11 15:52:37 31SVA620 0328 

Index

Protecting Children ......................... 32 Reclining the Seat-backs ................. 92 S


General Guideline ........................ 32 Recommended Shift Speeds ........ 206
Installing a Child Seat ................. 40 Refueling......................................... 187 Safety Belts................................... 8, 18
Protecting Infants ........................ 37 Reminder Indicators.................. 55, 57 Safety Defects, Reporting* .......... 314
Protecting Larger Children ........ 46 Remote Transmitter ........................ 86 Safety Features .................................. 7
Protecting Small Children .......... 38 Replacement Information Airbags ............................................ 9
Selecting a Child Seat.................. 39 Dust and Pollen Filter ............... 253 Seat Belts ........................................ 8
Using Child Seats with Engine Oil and Filter ................. 236 Safety Labels, Location of .............. 51
Tethers...................................... 45 Fuses ........................................... 284 Safety Messages ................................ ii
Using LATCH .............................. 41 Light Bulbs ................................. 246 Seat Belts ...................................... 8, 18
Maintenance Minder ................. 225 Additional Information ................ 18
R Spark Plugs................................. 296 Automatic Seat Belt
Tires and Wheels ....................... 262 Tensioners ................................ 19
Radiator Overheating .................... 279 Wiper Blades .............................. 253 Cleaning ...................................... 251
Radio/Disc Sound System ............ 120 Replacing Seat Belts After a Lap/Shoulder Belt ................. 14, 19
Radio/Disc/PC Card Sound Crash ............................................. 20 Maintenance ................................. 20
System......................................... 138 Reporting Safety Defects* ........... 314 Reminder Indicator and
Recommended Tire Pressures .... 257 Reserve Tank, Engine Beeper ................................. 18, 57
Radio Theft Protection.................. 179 Coolant ................................ 191, 238 System Components.................... 18
Readiness Codes .................... 282, 308 Restraint, Child ................................ 32 Use During Pregnancy................ 16
Rear Lights, Bulb Reverse Gear Position................... 209 Wearing a Lap/Shoulder
Replacement ............................... 250 Reverse Lockout ............................ 207 Belt ...................................... 14, 19
Rear Seat Access ............................. 93 Rotation, Tire ................................. 260 Seating Capacities.......................... 296

INDEX
Rear Seat, Folding ........................... 98 Seats .................................................. 92
Rear View Mirror........................... 104
Rear Window Defogger .................. 74 CONTINUED

VII
07/07/11 15:52:42 31SVA620 0329 

Index

Seats, Folding Rear.......................... 98 Speed Limiter ......................... 207, 210 Stereo Sound System .................... 119
Security System ............................. 181 SRS, Additional Information........... 21 Storing Your Vehicle ..................... 267
Selecting a Child Seat ...................... 39 Additional Safety Precautions .... 31 Supplemental Restraint
Serial Number ................................ 294 Airbag Service .............................. 30 System................................... 9, 21
Service Intervals ............................ 225 Airbag System Components ....... 21 Servicing ....................................... 30
Service Manual* ............................ 315 How the Passenger Airbag SRS Indicator.......................... 28, 58
Service Station Procedures .......... 187 Off Indicator Works ................ 29 System Components.................... 21
Setting the Clock ........................... 180 How the Side Airbag Off SVC .......................................... 124, 148
Shift Lever Position Indicators .... 208 Indicator Works ....................... 29 Synthetic Oil ................................... 235
Shift Lock Release ......................... 211 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 28
Side Airbags ................................. 9, 26 How Your Front Airbags T
Off Indicator ........................... 29, 58 Work.......................................... 23
Side Curtain Airbags ................... 9, 28 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 26 Taillights, Changing Bulbs ........... 250
Side Marker Lights, Bulb How Your Side Curtain Airbags Taking Care of the Unexpected .. 269
Replacement ............................... 249 Work.......................................... 28 Technical Descriptions
Signaling Turns ................................ 72 SRS Indicator.............................. 28, 58 DOT Tire Quality Grading* ..... 299
Snow Chains ................................... 263 START (Ignition Key Position) ..... 78 Emissions Control Systems ...... 305
Snow Tires ...................................... 263 Starting the Engine........................ 204 Oxygenated Fuels...................... 187
Sockets, Accessory Power ............ 108 In Cold Weather at High Three Way Catalytic
Sound System ................................. 119 Altitude ................................... 204 Converter........................ 306, 307
Spare Tire With a Dead Battery ................. 277 Temperature Gauge ........................ 68
Inflating ....................................... 270 Steam Coming from Engine ......... 279 Tether Anchor Points...................... 45
Specifications ............................. 298 Steering Wheel Theft Protection, Radio................. 179
Spark Plugs ..................................... 296 Adjustments ................................. 75 Three Way Catalytic
Specifications ................................. 296 Anti-theft Column Lock .............. 78 Converter ............................ 306, 307
Speed Control ................................. 182 Steering Wheel Buttons........ 177, 182 Tilt the Steering Wheel................... 75

VIII
07/07/11 15:52:48 31SVA620 0330 

Index

Time, Setting the ........................... 180 Tools, Tire Changing .................... 271 Uniform Tire Quality Grading* ... 299
Tire Chains ..................................... 263 Towing Unleaded Gasoline......................... 186
Tire, How to Change a Flat .......... 271 A Trailer ...................................... 221 Used Oil, How to Dispose of ........ 238
Tire Pressure Monitoring Emergency Wrecker ................. 290 Using a Booster Seat ....................... 47
System (TPMS) ......................... 218 Transmission
Tires ................................................ 255 Checking Fluid Level, V
Air Pressure ....................... 255, 257 Automatic ............................... 242
Chains ......................................... 263 Checking Fluid Level, Vanity Mirror ................................. 109
Checking Wear .......................... 258 Manual .................................... 243 Vehicle Capacity Load .................. 198
Compact Spare ........................... 270 Fluid Selection ................... 242, 243 Vehicle Dimensions....................... 296
DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 299 Identification Number ............... 295 Vehicle Identification Number..... 294
Inflation ....................................... 255 Shifting the Automatic .............. 208 Vehicle Storage .............................. 267
Inspection ................................... 258 Shifting the Manual ................... 205 Ventilation ...................................... 116
Labeling ...................................... 301 Treadwear* .................................... 299 VIN .................................................. 294
Low Tire Pressure Treadwear Indicators .................... 258 Viscosity, Oil................................... 235
Indicator............................ 61, 218 Trip Meter ........................................ 66
Maintenance ............................... 259 Trunk................................................. 90 W
Replacing .................................... 261 Emergency Opener ..................... 91
Rotating....................................... 260 Opening......................................... 90 WARNING, Explanation of .............. ii
Service Life ................................. 258 Open Indicator ............................. 63 Warning Button, Hazard ................. 74
Snow ............................................ 263 Turn Signals ..................................... 72 Warning Labels, Location of .......... 51
Specifications ............................. 298 Warranty Coverages ..................... 313
Summer Tires .................... 257, 262 U

INDEX
TPMS .......................................... 218
Wear ............................................ 260 Unexpected, Taking Care
Wheels ........................................ 264 of the ........................................... 269 CONTINUED

IX
07/07/11 15:52:51 31SVA620 0331 

Index

Washer, Windshield
Checking the Fluid Level ......... 241
Indicator ........................................ 63
Operation ...................................... 71
Wheels
Adjusting the Steering ................ 75
Alignment and Balance ............. 259
Compact Spare ........................... 270
Replacing .................................... 261
Wrench, Nut ............................... 272
Windows
Operating the Power ................. 100
Rear, Defogger ............................ 74
Windshield
Cleaning ........................................ 71
Defroster .................................... 118
Washers ........................................ 71
Wipers, Windshield
Changing Blades ........................ 253
Operation ...................................... 71
WMA ............................... 131, 151, 161
Worn Tires ..................................... 258
Wrecker, Emergency Towing ...... 290

: U.S. only

X
07/07/11 15:52:53 31SVA620 0332 
07/10/30 14:11:34 31SVA620 0333 

Service Information Summary

Gasoline: Automatic Transmission Fluid: Brake Fluid:


DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L: Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane Transmission Fluid) (see page DOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 or
number of 87 or higher. 242 ). DOT 4 brake fluid as a temporary
Si: replacement (see page 244 ).
Premium unleaded gasoline, Manual Transmission Fluid:
pump octane number of 91 or Honda Manual Transmission Tire Pressure (measured cold):
higher. Fluid preferred, or an SAE 10W-30 DX, Canadian DX-G
or 10W-40 motor oil as a Front/Rear:
Fuel Tank Capacity: temporary replacement (see page 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
13.2 US gal (50 ) 243 ). LX, EX, EX-L
Front/Rear:
Recommended Engine Oil: Capacity (including differential): 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L: DX, Canadian DX-G, LX, EX, EX-L: Si
API Premium grade 5W-20 1.5 US qt (1.4 ) Front/Rear:
detergent oil (see page 235 ). Si: 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
1.6 US qt (1.5 )
Oil change capacity (including Spare Tire:
filter): Power Steering Fluid: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
3.9 US qt (3.7 ) All models except Si and
Si: Canadian DX-G (M/T):
API Premium grade 5W-30 Honda Power Steering Fluid
detergent oil (see page 235 ). preferred, or another brand of
Oil change capacity (including power steering fluid as a
filter): temporary replacement. Do not
4.6 US qt (4.4 ) use ATF (see page 245 ).

Você também pode gostar